blob: 35ef286aae8ef61bf5c3264b8a59d9aba2d405eb [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200593 - tune.buffers.limit
594 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200595 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200596 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100597 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100598 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200599 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100600 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100601 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100602 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100603 - tune.lua.session-timeout
604 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200605 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100606 - tune.maxaccept
607 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200608 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200609 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200610 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100611 - tune.rcvbuf.client
612 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100613 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100614 - tune.sndbuf.client
615 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100616 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100617 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200618 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100619 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200620 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200621 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100622 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200623 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100624 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200625 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
626 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
627 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100628 - tune.zlib.memlevel
629 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100630
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200631 * Debugging
632 - debug
633 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634
635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006363.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637------------------------------------
638
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200639ca-base <dir>
640 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200641 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
642 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200643
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200644chroot <jail dir>
645 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
646 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
647 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
648 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
649 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
650 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100651
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100652cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
653 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
654 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
655 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100656 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
657 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
658 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
659 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
660 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
661 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
662 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
663 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
664 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
665 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100666
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200667crt-base <dir>
668 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
669 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
670 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200672daemon
673 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
674 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
675 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
676
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200677deviceatlas-json-file <path>
678 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
679 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
680
681deviceatlas-log-level <value>
682 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
683 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
684
685deviceatlas-separator <char>
686 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
687 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
688
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100689deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200690 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
691 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
692 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100693
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900694external-check
695 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
696 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
697 See "option external-check".
698
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200699gid <number>
700 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
701 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
702 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100703 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
704 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200705 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100706
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100707hard-stop-after <time>
708 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
709
710 Arguments :
711 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
712 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
713 SIGUSR1 signal.
714
715 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
716 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
717 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
718
719 Example:
720 global
721 hard-stop-after 30s
722
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200723group <group name>
724 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
725 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100726
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200727log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200728 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
729 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100730 configured with "log global".
731
732 <address> can be one of:
733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100734 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100735 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
736 port).
737
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100738 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
739 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
740 port).
741
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100742 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
743 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
744 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
745 writeable).
746
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200747 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
748 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100749
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200750 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
751 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
752 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
753 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
754 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
755 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
756 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
757 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
758 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
759 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
760 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
761
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200762 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
763 one of the following :
764
765 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
766 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
767
768 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
769 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
770
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100771 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200772
773 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
774 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
775 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
776
777 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200778 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
779 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
780 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
781 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
782 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
783 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200784
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200785 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200786
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100787log-send-hostname [<string>]
788 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
789 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
790 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
791 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
792 the logs.
793
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000794log-tag <string>
795 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
796 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
797 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100798 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000799
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100800lua-load <file>
801 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
802 used multiple times.
803
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200804nbproc <number>
805 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
806 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
807 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
808 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
809 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
810
811pidfile <pidfile>
812 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
813 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
814 starting the process. See also "daemon".
815
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100816presetenv <name> <value>
817 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
818 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
819 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
820 and "unsetenv".
821
822resetenv [<name> ...]
823 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
824 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
825 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
826 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
827 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
828 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
829 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
830 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
831
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100832stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200833 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
834 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
835 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
836 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
837 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
838 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100839 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200840 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
841 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200842
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200843server-state-base <directory>
844 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200845 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
846 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200847
848server-state-file <file>
849 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
850 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
851 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
852 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
853 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
854 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
855 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
856 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200857 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
858 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200859
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100860setenv <name> <value>
861 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
862 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
863 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
864 and "unsetenv".
865
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100866ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
867 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
868 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300869 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100870 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
871 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
872 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
873 "bind" keyword for more information.
874
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100875ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
877 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
878 keyword to see available options.
879
880 Example:
881 global
882 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
883
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100884ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
886 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300887 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100888 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
889 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
890 information.
891
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100892ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
893 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
894 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
895 keyword to see available options.
896
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200897ssl-dh-param-file <file>
898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
899 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
900 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
901 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
902 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200903 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
904 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
905 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
906 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200907 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
908 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
909 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
910
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100911ssl-server-verify [none|required]
912 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
913 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
914 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
915
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200916stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
917 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
918 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
919 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200920 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
921 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200922
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200923 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
924 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
925 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200926
927stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
928 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
929 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100930 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200931
932stats maxconn <connections>
933 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
934 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
935
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200936uid <number>
937 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
938 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
939 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
940 one. See also "gid" and "user".
941
942ulimit-n <number>
943 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
944 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
945 option.
946
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100947unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
948 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
949
950 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
951 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
952 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
953 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
954 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
955 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
956 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
957 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
958 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
959 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
960
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100961unsetenv [<name> ...]
962 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
963 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
964 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
965 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
966 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
967 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
968 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
969
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970user <user name>
971 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
972 See also "uid" and "group".
973
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200974node <name>
975 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
976
977 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
978 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
979 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
980 traffic.
981
982description <text>
983 Add a text that describes the instance.
984
985 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
986 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
987 "<" and ">" characters.
988
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010098951degrees-data-file <file path>
990 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
991 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
992
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200993 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100994 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
995
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000099651degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100997 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
998 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
999 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1000
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001001 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001002 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1003
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200100451degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001005 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1006 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1007
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001008 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1009 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1010
101151degrees-cache-size <number>
1012 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1013 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1014 By default, this cache is disabled.
1015
1016 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001017 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1018
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001019wurfl-data-file <file path>
1020 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1021 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1022
1023 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1024 with USE_WURFL=1.
1025
1026wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1027 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1028 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1029 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1030
1031 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1032
1033 Valid WURFL properties are:
1034 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1035
1036 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1037 device.
1038
1039 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1040 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1041
1042 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1043 particular web request.
1044
1045 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1046 used Libwurfl API version.
1047
1048 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1049 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1050 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1051
1052 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1053 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1054
1055 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1056 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1057
1058 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1059
1060 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1061
1062 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1063 with USE_WURFL=1.
1064
1065wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1066 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1067 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1068
1069 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1070 with USE_WURFL=1.
1071
1072wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1073 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1074 thus before the chroot.
1075
1076 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1077 with USE_WURFL=1.
1078
1079wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1080 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1081 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1082 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1083 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1084 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1085 mode is enabled by default.
1086
1087 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1088 with USE_WURFL=1.
1089
1090wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1091 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1092 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1093 - "0" : no cache is used.
1094 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1095 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1096 the highest performing option.
1097
1098 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1099 with USE_WURFL=1.
1100
1101wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1102 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1103 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1104
1105 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1106 with USE_WURFL=1.
1107
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011093.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110-----------------------
1111
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001112max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1113 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1114 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1115 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1116 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1117 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1118 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1119 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1120 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1121
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001122maxconn <number>
1123 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1124 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1125 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001126 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1127 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1128 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1129 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001130 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1131 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1132 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1133 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1134 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001136maxconnrate <number>
1137 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1138 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1139 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1140 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1141 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1142 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1143 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1144 fairness.
1145
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001146maxcomprate <number>
1147 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001148 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001149 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1150 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1151 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1152 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1153 default value.
1154
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001155maxcompcpuusage <number>
1156 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1157 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1158 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1159 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1160 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1161 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1162 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1163 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1164
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001165maxpipes <number>
1166 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1167 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1168 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1169 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1170 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1171 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1172
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001173maxsessrate <number>
1174 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1175 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1176 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1177 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1178 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1179 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1180 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1181 fairness.
1182
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001183maxsslconn <number>
1184 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1185 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1186 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1187 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1188 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1189 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1190 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001191 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1192 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1193 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1194 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1195 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1196 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1197 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001198
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001199maxsslrate <number>
1200 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1201 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1202 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1203 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1204 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1205 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1206 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1207 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1208 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1209 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1210
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001211maxzlibmem <number>
1212 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1213 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1214 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001215 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1216 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1217 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1218
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001219noepoll
1220 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1221 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001222 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001223
1224nokqueue
1225 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1226 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1227 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1228
1229nopoll
1230 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1231 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001232 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001233 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001234
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001235nosplice
1236 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1237 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1238 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001239 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001240 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1241 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1242 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1243 "option splice-response".
1244
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001245nogetaddrinfo
1246 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1247 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1248
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001249noreuseport
1250 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1251 command line argument "-dR".
1252
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001253spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001254 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1255 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1256 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1257 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1258 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1259 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001260
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001261tune.buffers.limit <number>
1262 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1263 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1264 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1265 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1266 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1267 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1268 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1269 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1270 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1271 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1272 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1273 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1274 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1275 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1276 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1277
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001278tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1279 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1280 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1281 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1282 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1283
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001284tune.bufsize <number>
1285 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1286 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1287 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1288 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1289 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1290 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1291 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1292 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001293 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1294 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1295 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001296
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001297tune.chksize <number>
1298 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1299 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1300 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1301 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1302 checks whenever possible.
1303
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001304tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1305 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1306 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1307 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1308 this value. The default value is 1.
1309
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001310tune.http.cookielen <number>
1311 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1312 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1313 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1314 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1315 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1316 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1317 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1318 to change this value.
1319
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001320tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1321 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1322 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1323 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1324 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1325 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1326 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1327 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1328 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1329 limit too high.
1330
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001331tune.idletimer <timeout>
1332 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1333 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1334 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1335 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1336 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1337 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1338 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1339 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1340 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1341
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001342tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1343 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001344 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001345 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1346 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1347 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1348 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1349 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1350
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001351tune.lua.maxmem
1352 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1353 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1354 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1355 memory.
1356
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001357tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1358 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001359 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1360 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1361 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001362
1363tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1364 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1365 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1366 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1367 check servers.
1368
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001369tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1370 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1371 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1372 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1373 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1374
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001375tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001376 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1377 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1378 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1379 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1380 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1381 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1382 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1383 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1384 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1385 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001386
1387tune.maxpollevents <number>
1388 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1389 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1390 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1391 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1392 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1393
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001394tune.maxrewrite <number>
1395 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1396 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1397 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1398 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1399 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1400 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1401 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1402 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1403 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1404 bufsize.
1405
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001406tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1407 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1408 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1409 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1410 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1411 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1412 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1413 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1414 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1415 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1416 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1417 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1418 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1419 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1420 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1421 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1422 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1423 setting this parameter to 0.
1424
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001425tune.pipesize <number>
1426 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1427 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1428 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1429 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1430 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1431 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1432
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001433tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1434tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1435 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1436 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1437 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1438 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1439 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1440 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1441 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1442
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001443tune.recv_enough <number>
1444 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1445 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1446 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1447 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1448 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1449
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001450tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1451tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1452 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1453 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1454 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1455 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1456 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1457 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1458 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1459 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1460 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1461 notifying haproxy again.
1462
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001463tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001464 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1465 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1466 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001467 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001468 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1469 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1470 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1471 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1472 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001473 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1474 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001475
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001476tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1477 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1478 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1479 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1480 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1481 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1482 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1483
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001484tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1485 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001486 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001487 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1488 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1489 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1490 being used for too long.
1491
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001492tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1493 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1494 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1495 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1496 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1497 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1498 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1499 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1500 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1501 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1502 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001503 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1504 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001505
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001506tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1507 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1508 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1509 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1510 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1511 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1512 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1513 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001514 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1515 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001516
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001517tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1518 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1519 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1520 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1521 1000 entries.
1522
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001523tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1524 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1525 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1526 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1527
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001528tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001529tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001530tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1531tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1532tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001533 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1534 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1535 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1536 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1537 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1538 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1539 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1540 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001541
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001542 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1543 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1544 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1545 all available space is consumed.
1546 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1547 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1548 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001549
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001550tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1551 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001552 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001553 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1554 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1555 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1556
1557tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1558 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1559 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1560 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1561 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001562
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015633.3. Debugging
1564--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001565
1566debug
1567 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1568 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1569 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1570 system startup.
1571
1572quiet
1573 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1574 line argument "-q".
1575
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001576
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015773.4. Userlists
1578--------------
1579It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1580http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1581it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1582
1583userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001584 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001585 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1586
1587group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001588 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001589 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1590 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1591
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001592user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1593 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001594 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1595 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001596 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1597 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001598 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001599 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001600
1601
1602 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001603 userlist L1
1604 group G1 users tiger,scott
1605 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001606
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001607 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1608 user scott insecure-password elgato
1609 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001610
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001611 userlist L2
1612 group G1
1613 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001614
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001615 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1616 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1617 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001618
1619 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001620
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001621
16223.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001623----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001624It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1625several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1626instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1627values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1628automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1629In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1630using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1631tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1632reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1633Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1634that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1635each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001636
1637peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001638 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001639 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1640
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001641disabled
1642 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1643 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1644 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1645
1646enable
1647 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1648
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001649peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1650 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1651 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1652 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1653 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1654 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1655 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1656
1657 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1658 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1659
1660 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1661 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1662 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1663 across all peers.
1664
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001665 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1666 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001667
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001668 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001669 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001670 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1671 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1672 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001673
1674 backend mybackend
1675 mode tcp
1676 balance roundrobin
1677 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1678 stick on src
1679
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001680 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1681 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001682
1683
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016843.6. Mailers
1685------------
1686It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1687If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1688in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1689
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001690mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001691 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1692 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1693
1694mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1695 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1696
1697 Example:
1698 mailers mymailers
1699 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1700 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1701
1702 backend mybackend
1703 mode tcp
1704 balance roundrobin
1705
1706 email-alert mailers mymailers
1707 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1708 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1709
1710 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1711 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1712
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001713timeout mail <time>
1714 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1715 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1716 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1717 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1718
1719 Example:
1720 mailers mymailers
1721 timeout mail 20s
1722 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017244. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001725----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001728 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001729 - frontend <name>
1730 - backend <name>
1731 - listen <name>
1732
1733A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1734its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1735section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001736section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001737
1738A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1739connections.
1740
1741A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1742to forward incoming connections.
1743
1744A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1745parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001747All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1748'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1749case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1750
1751Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1752logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1753proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1754However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1755name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1756
1757Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1758and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001759bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001760protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1761modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1762arbitrary criteria.
1763
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001764In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1765a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1766the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1767
1768 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1769 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1770 between responses and new requests.
1771
1772 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1773 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1774 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1775 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1776
1777 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1778 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1779 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1780
1781 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1782 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1783 client-facing connection remains open.
1784
1785 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1786 after the end of the response.
1787
1788The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1789frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1790following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1791weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1792
1793 Backend mode
1794
1795 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1796 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1797 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1798 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1799 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1800 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1801 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1802 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1803 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1804 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1805 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1806
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001807
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001808
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018094.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1810--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001812The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1813limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1814they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1815limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001816marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001817option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001818and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1819with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1820specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001822
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1824------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1825acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001826appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001827backlog X X X -
1828balance X - X X
1829bind - X X -
1830bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001831block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001832capture cookie - X X -
1833capture request header - X X -
1834capture response header - X X -
1835clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001836compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001837contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1838cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001839declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001840default-server X - X X
1841default_backend X X X -
1842description - X X X
1843disabled X X X X
1844dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001845email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001846email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001847email-alert mailers X X X X
1848email-alert myhostname X X X X
1849email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001850enabled X X X X
1851errorfile X X X X
1852errorloc X X X X
1853errorloc302 X X X X
1854-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1855errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001856force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001857filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001858fullconn X - X X
1859grace X X X X
1860hash-type X - X X
1861http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001862http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001863http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001864http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001865http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001866http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001867http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001868id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001869ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001870load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001871log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001872log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001873log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001874log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001875max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876maxconn X X X -
1877mode X X X X
1878monitor fail - X X -
1879monitor-net X X X -
1880monitor-uri X X X -
1881option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1882option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1883option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1884option allbackups (*) X - X X
1885option checkcache (*) X - X X
1886option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1887option contstats (*) X X X -
1888option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1889option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1890option forceclose (*) X X X X
1891-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1892option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001893option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001894option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001895option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001896option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001897option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001898option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001899option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1901option httpchk X - X X
1902option httpclose (*) X X X X
1903option httplog X X X X
1904option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001905option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001906option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001907option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1909option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1910option logasap (*) X X X -
1911option mysql-check X - X X
1912option nolinger (*) X X X X
1913option originalto X X X X
1914option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001915option pgsql-check X - X X
1916option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001917option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001918option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001919option smtpchk X - X X
1920option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1921option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1922option splice-request (*) X X X X
1923option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001924option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001925option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1926option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1927-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001928option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001929option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1930option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1931option tcpka X X X X
1932option tcplog X X X X
1933option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001934external-check command X - X X
1935external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1937rate-limit sessions X X X -
1938redirect - X X X
1939redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1940redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1941reqadd - X X X
1942reqallow - X X X
1943reqdel - X X X
1944reqdeny - X X X
1945reqiallow - X X X
1946reqidel - X X X
1947reqideny - X X X
1948reqipass - X X X
1949reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001950reqitarpit - X X X
1951reqpass - X X X
1952reqrep - X X X
1953-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001954reqtarpit - X X X
1955retries X - X X
1956rspadd - X X X
1957rspdel - X X X
1958rspdeny - X X X
1959rspidel - X X X
1960rspideny - X X X
1961rspirep - X X X
1962rsprep - X X X
1963server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001964server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001965source X - X X
1966srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001967stats admin - X X X
1968stats auth X X X X
1969stats enable X X X X
1970stats hide-version X X X X
1971stats http-request - X X X
1972stats realm X X X X
1973stats refresh X X X X
1974stats scope X X X X
1975stats show-desc X X X X
1976stats show-legends X X X X
1977stats show-node X X X X
1978stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001979-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1980stick match - - X X
1981stick on - - X X
1982stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001983stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001984stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001985tcp-check connect - - X X
1986tcp-check expect - - X X
1987tcp-check send - - X X
1988tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001989tcp-request connection - X X -
1990tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001991tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001992tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001993tcp-response content - - X X
1994tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995timeout check X - X X
1996timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001997timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001998timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1999timeout connect X - X X
2000timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2001timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2002timeout http-request X X X X
2003timeout queue X - X X
2004timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002005timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002006timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2007timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002008timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002009transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002010unique-id-format X X X -
2011unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002012use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002013use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002014------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2015 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020184.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2019---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002020
2021This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2022
2023
2024acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2025 Declare or complete an access list.
2026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2027 no | yes | yes | yes
2028 Example:
2029 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2030 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2031 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002033 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002034
2035
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002036appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2037 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002038 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2040 no | no | yes | yes
2041 Arguments :
2042 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2043 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2044
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002045 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002046 checked in each cookie value.
2047
2048 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2049 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2050 milliseconds.
2051
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002052 request-learn
2053 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2054 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2055 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2056 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2057 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2058 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2059
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002060 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2061 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2062 data following this prefix.
2063
2064 Example :
2065 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2066
2067 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2068 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2069
2070 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2071 2 modes are currently supported :
2072 - path-parameters :
2073 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2074 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2075 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2076 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2077 - query-string :
2078 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2079 query string.
2080
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002081 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2082 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2083 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002084
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002085 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2086 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002087
2088
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002089backlog <conns>
2090 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2092 yes | yes | yes | no
2093 Arguments :
2094 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2095 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002096 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002097
2098 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2099 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2100 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2101 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2102 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2103 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2104 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2105 backlog parameter.
2106
2107 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2108 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2109 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2110
2111 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2112
2113
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002114balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002115balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002116 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2118 yes | no | yes | yes
2119 Arguments :
2120 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2121 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2122 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2123 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2124
2125 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2126 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2127 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2128 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002129 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002130 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002131 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2132 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2133 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2134 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2135 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2136 it, so that you don't worry.
2137
2138 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2139 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2140 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2141 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2142 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2143 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2144 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2145 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002146
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002147 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2148 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2149 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2150 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2151 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2152 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2153 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2154 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2155
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002156 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002157 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002158 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2159 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002160 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002161 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2162 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2163 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2164 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2165 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002166 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2167 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2168 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2169 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2170 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2171 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002172
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002173 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2174 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2175 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2176 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2177 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2178 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2179 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2180 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002181 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002183 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2184 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2185 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002186
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002187 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2188 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2189 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2190 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2191 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2192 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2193 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2194 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2195 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2196 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2197 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2198 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002199
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002200 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002201 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2202 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2203 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2204 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2205 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2206 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2207 URIs start with a leading "/".
2208
2209 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2210 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2211 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2212 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002214 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002215 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2216
2217 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002218 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2219 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002220 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2221 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2222 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2223 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002224 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002225 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2226 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002227
2228 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2229 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2230 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2231 server will receive the request.
2232
2233 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2234 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2235 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2236 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2237 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002238 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2239 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2240 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002241
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002242 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2243 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2244 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2245 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2246 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002247
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002248 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002249 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2250 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2251 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2252
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002253 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2254 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2255 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2256
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002257 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002258 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002259 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2260 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2261 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2262 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2263 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2264 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002265 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002266 used instead.
2267
2268 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2269 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2270 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2271 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2272
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002273 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2274 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2275 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2276
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002277 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002278
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002279 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002280 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2281 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002282
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002283 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2284 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2285 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002286
2287 Examples :
2288 balance roundrobin
2289 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002290 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002291 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2292 balance hdr(host)
2293 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002294
2295 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2296 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2297
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002298 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002299 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2300 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2301 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2302 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2303
2304 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2305 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2306 defaults to 16 kB.
2307
2308 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2309 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2310
2311 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2312 Round Robin.
2313
2314 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2315 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2316 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2317 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2318
2319 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2320
2321 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002322 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002323 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2324 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2325 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002327 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002328
2329
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002330bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2331bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002332 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2334 no | yes | yes | no
2335 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002336 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2337 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2338 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2339 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002340 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002341 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2342 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2343 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2344 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2345 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2346 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2347 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002348 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2349 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2350 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2351 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2352 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2353 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2354 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002355 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2356 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2357 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002358 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2359 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2360 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002361
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002362 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2363 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002364 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2365 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2366 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002367 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2368 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2369 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2370 the range.
2371
2372 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2373 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2374 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2375 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2376 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2377 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2378 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002379 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002380 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002381
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002382 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2383 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2384 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2385 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2386 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2387 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2388 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2389 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2390
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002391 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2392 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2393 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2394 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002395
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002396 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2397 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2398 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2399 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2400 in a frontend.
2401
2402 Example :
2403 listen http_proxy
2404 bind :80,:443
2405 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002406 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002407
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002408 listen http_https_proxy
2409 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002410 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002411
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002412 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2413 bind ipv6@:80
2414 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2415 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2416
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002417 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002418 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002419
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002420 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2421 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2422 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2423 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2424 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2425
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002426 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002427 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428
2429
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002430bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002431 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2433 yes | yes | yes | yes
2434 Arguments :
2435 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2436 may be used to override a default value.
2437
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002438 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002439 option may be combined with other numbers.
2440
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002441 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002442 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2443 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2444 missing from all processes.
2445
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002446 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002447 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002448 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2449 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2450 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2451 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002452
2453 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2454 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2455 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2456 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2457 and 'even' instances.
2458
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002459 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2460 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2461 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2462 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002463
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002464 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2465 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2466
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002467 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2468 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2469 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2470
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002471 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2472 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2473
2474 Example :
2475 listen app_ip1
2476 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002477 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002478
2479 listen app_ip2
2480 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002481 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002482
2483 listen management
2484 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002485 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002486
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002487 listen management
2488 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2489 bind-process 1-4
2490
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002491 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002492
2493
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002494block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002495 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2497 no | yes | yes | yes
2498
2499 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2500 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002501 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002502 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002503 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2504 "block" statements per instance.
2505
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002506 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2507 "http-request deny" instead.
2508
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002509 Example:
2510 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2511 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2512 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2513 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2514
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002516
2517
2518capture cookie <name> len <length>
2519 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2520 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2521 no | yes | yes | no
2522 Arguments :
2523 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2524 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2525 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2526 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2527 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2528
2529 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2530 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2531 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2532 right if it exceeds <length>.
2533
2534 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2535 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2536 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2537 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2538
2539 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2540 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2541 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2542
2543 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2544 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2545 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002546 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2547 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2548 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002549
2550 Example:
2551 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2552
2553 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002554 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555
2556
2557capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002558 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2560 no | yes | yes | no
2561 Arguments :
2562 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002563 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002564 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2565 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2566 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2567
2568 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2569 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2570 it exceeds <length>.
2571
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002572 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002573 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2574 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002575 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2576 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2577 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2578 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002579 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002580 environments to find where the request came from.
2581
2582 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2583 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2584 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2585 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002586
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002587 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2588 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2589 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2590 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2591 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592
2593 Example:
2594 capture request header Host len 15
2595 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002596 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002598 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002599 about logging.
2600
2601
2602capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002603 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002604 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2605 no | yes | yes | no
2606 Arguments :
2607 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002608 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002609 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2610 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2611 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2612
2613 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2614 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2615 it exceeds <length>.
2616
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002617 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002618 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2619 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2620 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002621 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2622 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2623 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2624 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002625
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002626 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2627 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2628 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2629 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2630 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002631
2632 Example:
2633 capture response header Content-length len 9
2634 capture response header Location len 15
2635
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002636 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002637 about logging.
2638
2639
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002640clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2643 yes | yes | yes | no
2644 Arguments :
2645 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2646 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2647 as explained at the top of this document.
2648
2649 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2650 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2651 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2652 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2653 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2654 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2655 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2656 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002657 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002658 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2659 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2660
2661 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2662 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2663 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2664 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2665 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2666 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2667
2668 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2669 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2670
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002671 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2672 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002674compression algo <algorithm> ...
2675compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002676compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002677 Enable HTTP compression.
2678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2679 yes | yes | yes | yes
2680 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002681 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2682 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2683 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2684
2685 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002686 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2687 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2688 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002689
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002690 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002691 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002692
2693 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2694 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2695 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2696 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2697 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002698 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002699
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002700 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2701 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2702 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2703 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2704 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2705 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2706 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002707 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002708
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002709 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002710 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002711 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2712 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2713 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2714 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2715 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002716
2717 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2718 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2719 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2720 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2721 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002722 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2723 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2724 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2725 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2726 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002727 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2728 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002729
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002730 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002731 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2732 "Accept-Encoding" header
2733 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002734 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002735 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2736 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002737 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2738 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2739 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2740 "multipart"
2741 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2742 header
2743 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2744 and later
2745 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2746 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002747
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002748 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2749 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002750
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002751 Examples :
2752 compression algo gzip
2753 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002754
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002755
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002756contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002757 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2759 yes | no | yes | yes
2760 Arguments :
2761 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2762 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2763 as explained at the top of this document.
2764
2765 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002766 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002767 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002768 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2769 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2770 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2771 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2772
2773 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2774 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2775 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2776 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2777 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2778 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2779
2780 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2781 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2782 instead.
2783
2784 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2785 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2786
2787
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002788cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002789 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2790 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002791 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002792 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2793 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2794 yes | no | yes | yes
2795 Arguments :
2796 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2797 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2798 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2799 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2800 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2801 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2802 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2803 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2804 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2805
2806 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2807 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2808 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2809 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2810 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2811 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002812 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2813 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2814 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2815 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2816 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002817
2818 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002819 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002820
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002821 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002822 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2823 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2824 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2825 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2826 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2827 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2828 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2829 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2830 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2831 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002832
2833 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2834 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2835 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2836 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2837 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2838 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2839 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2840 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2841 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002842 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002843 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2844 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2845 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002846
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002847 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2848 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2849 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002850 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2851 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2852 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2853 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002854 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2855 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2856 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002857
2858 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2859 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2860 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2861 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2862 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2863 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2864 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2865 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2866 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2867
2868 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2869 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2870 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2871 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2872 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2873 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2874 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2875 persistence cookie in the cache.
2876 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2877
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002878 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2879 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2880 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2881 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2882 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2883 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2884 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2885 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2886 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2887 they logout.
2888
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002889 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2890 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2891 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2892 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2893
2894 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2895 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2896 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2897 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2898 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2899 this attribute.
2900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002901 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002902 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002903 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2904 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2905 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2906 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2907 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2908 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002909
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002910 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2911 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2912 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2913 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2914 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2915 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2916 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2917 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2918 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2919 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2920 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2921 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2922 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2923 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2924 the site.
2925
2926 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2927 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2928 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2929 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2930 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2931 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2932 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2933 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2934 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2935 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2936 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2937 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2938 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2939 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2940 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2941 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2942
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002943 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2944 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2945 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2946 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2947 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2948 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002950 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2951 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2952 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2953 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002954
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002955 Examples :
2956 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2957 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2958 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002959 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002960
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002961 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002962
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002963
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002964declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2965 Declares a capture slot.
2966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2967 no | yes | yes | no
2968 Arguments:
2969 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2970
2971 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2972 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2973 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2974 for use in the response.
2975
2976 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002977 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002978 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2979
2980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002981default-server [param*]
2982 Change default options for a server in a backend
2983 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2984 yes | no | yes | yes
2985 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002986 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2987 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2988 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2989 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002990
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002991 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002992 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2993
2994 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002995
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997default_backend <backend>
2998 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3000 yes | yes | yes | no
3001 Arguments :
3002 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3003
3004 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3005 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3006 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3007 will catch all undetermined requests.
3008
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003009 Example :
3010
3011 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3012 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3013 default_backend dynamic
3014
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003015 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003016
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003017
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003018description <string>
3019 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3021 no | yes | yes | yes
3022 Arguments : string
3023
3024 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3025 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3026 it describes.
3027 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3028
3029
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003030disabled
3031 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3033 yes | yes | yes | yes
3034 Arguments : none
3035
3036 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3037 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3038 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3039 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3040 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3041 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3042 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3043
3044 See also : "enabled"
3045
3046
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003047dispatch <address>:<port>
3048 Set a default server address
3049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3050 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003051 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003052
3053 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3054 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3055 during start-up.
3056
3057 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3058 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3059 possible with normal servers.
3060
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003061 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003062 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3063 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3064 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3065 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3066
3067 See also : "server"
3068
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003069
3070dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3071 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3073 yes | no | yes | yes
3074 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3075
3076 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3077 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3078 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3079 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3080 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3081 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003082
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003083enabled
3084 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3086 yes | yes | yes | yes
3087 Arguments : none
3088
3089 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3090 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3091
3092 See also : "disabled"
3093
3094
3095errorfile <code> <file>
3096 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3097 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3098 yes | yes | yes | yes
3099 Arguments :
3100 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003101 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3102 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003103
3104 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003105 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003106 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003107 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3108 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003109
3110 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3111 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3112 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3113
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003114 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3115
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003116 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3117 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3118 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3119 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3120
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003121 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3122 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3123 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3124 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3125 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3126 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3127
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003128 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3129 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3130 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003131 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003132 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3133
3134 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3135
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003136 Example :
3137 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003138 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003139 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3140 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3141
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003142
3143errorloc <code> <url>
3144errorloc302 <code> <url>
3145 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3147 yes | yes | yes | yes
3148 Arguments :
3149 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003150 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003151
3152 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3153 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3154 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3155 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3156 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3157
3158 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3159 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3160 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3161
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003162 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3163
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003164 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3165 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3166 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3167 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003168 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003169 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3170 request.
3171
3172 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3173
3174
3175errorloc303 <code> <url>
3176 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3178 yes | yes | yes | yes
3179 Arguments :
3180 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3181 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3182
3183 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3184 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3185 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3186 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3187 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3188
3189 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3190 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3191 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3192
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003193 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3194
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003195 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3196 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3197 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3198 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003199 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003200
3201 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3202
3203
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003204email-alert from <emailaddr>
3205 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3206 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3208 yes | yes | yes | yes
3209
3210 Arguments :
3211
3212 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3213
3214 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3215 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3216
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003217 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003218 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3219 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003220
3221
3222email-alert level <level>
3223 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3224 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3225 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3226 yes | yes | yes | yes
3227
3228 Arguments :
3229
3230 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3231 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3232 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3233
3234 By default level is alert
3235
3236 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3237 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3238 for the proxy.
3239
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003240 Alerts are sent when :
3241
3242 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3243 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3244 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3245 is notice or lower
3246 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3247 and a health check status update occurs
3248
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003249 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3250 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003251 section 3.6 about mailers.
3252
3253
3254email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3255 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3256 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3257 yes | yes | yes | yes
3258
3259 Arguments :
3260
3261 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3262
3263 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3264 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3265
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003266 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3267 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003268
3269
3270email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3271 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3272 mailers.
3273 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3274 yes | yes | yes | yes
3275
3276 Arguments :
3277
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003278 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003279
3280 By default the systems hostname is used.
3281
3282 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3283 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3284 for the proxy.
3285
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003286 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3287 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003288
3289
3290email-alert to <emailaddr>
3291 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3292 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3293 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3294 yes | yes | yes | yes
3295
3296 Arguments :
3297
3298 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3299
3300 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3301 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3302
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003303 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003304 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3305
3306
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003307force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3308 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3310 no | yes | yes | yes
3311
3312 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3313 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3314 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3315 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3316 marked down for maintenance operations.
3317
3318 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3319 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3320 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3321 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3322 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3323 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3324 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3325 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3326 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3327
3328 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3329 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3330 is used.
3331
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003332 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003333 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003334
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003335
3336filter <name> [param*]
3337 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3338 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3339 no | yes | yes | yes
3340 Arguments :
3341 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3342 referenced in section 9.
3343
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003344 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003345 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003346 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3347 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003348
3349 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3350 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3351
3352 Example:
3353 listen
3354 bind *:80
3355
3356 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3357 filter compression
3358 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3359
3360 compression algo gzip
3361 compression offload
3362
3363 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3364
3365 See also : section 9.
3366
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003367
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003368fullconn <conns>
3369 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3371 yes | no | yes | yes
3372 Arguments :
3373 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3374 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3375
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003376 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003377 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003378 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003379 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3380 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3381 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3382 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3383 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003384 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003385
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003386 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3387 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003388 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3389 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3390 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003391
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003392 Example :
3393 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3394 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3395 # connections.
3396 backend dynamic
3397 fullconn 10000
3398 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3399 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3400
3401 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3402
3403
3404grace <time>
3405 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003407 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003408 Arguments :
3409 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3410 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3411 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3412
3413 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3414 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003415 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003416 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3417
3418 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3419 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3420 simplify it.
3421
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003422
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003423hash-balance-factor <factor>
3424 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3425 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3426 yes | no | no | yes
3427 Arguments :
3428 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3429 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3430 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3431
3432 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3433 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3434 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3435 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3436 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3437 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3438 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3439
3440 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3441 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3442 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3443 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3444 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3445
3446 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3447
3448
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003449hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003450 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3451 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3452 yes | no | yes | yes
3453 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003454 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3455 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003456
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003457 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3458 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3459 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3460 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3461 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3462 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3463 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3464 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3465 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3466 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003467
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003468 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3469 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3470 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3471 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3472 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3473 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3474 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3475 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3476 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3477 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3478 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3479 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3480 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003481 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3482 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003483
3484 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3485
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003486 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003487 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3488 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3489 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003490 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3491 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3492 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003493
3494 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3495 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003496 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3497 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3498 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3499 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3500
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003501 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3502 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3503 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3504 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3505 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3506 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3507 parameter.
3508
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003509 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3510 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3511 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3512 used on strings.
3513
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003514 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3515
3516 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3517 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3518 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3519 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3520 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3521 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3522 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3523 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3524 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3525 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3526 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3527 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003528
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003529 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3530 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3531 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003532
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003533 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003534
3535
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003536http-check disable-on-404
3537 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003539 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003540 Arguments : none
3541
3542 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3543 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3544 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3545 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3546 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3547 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3548 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3549 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003550 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3551 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3552 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3553
3554 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3555
3556
3557http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003558 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003559 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003560 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003561 Arguments :
3562 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3563 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003564 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003565 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3566 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3567 details on the supported keywords.
3568
3569 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3570 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3571 with the usual backslash ('\').
3572
3573 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3574 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3575 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3576 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3577 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3578
3579 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003580 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003581 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3582 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3583 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3584
3585 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003586 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003587 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3588 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3589 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3590 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3591
3592 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003593 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003594 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3595 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3596 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3597 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3598 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3599 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3600 trace).
3601
3602 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003603 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003604 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3605 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3606 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3607 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3608 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3609 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3610
3611 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3612 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3613 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3614 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3615 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3616 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3617 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3618 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3619
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003620 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3621 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3622 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3623
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003624 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3625 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3626
3627 Examples :
3628 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003629 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003630
3631 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003632 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003633
3634 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003635 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003636
3637 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003638 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003640 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003641
3642
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003643http-check send-state
3644 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3646 yes | no | yes | yes
3647 Arguments : none
3648
3649 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3650 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3651 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3652 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3653 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3654
3655 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3656 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3657 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3658 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3659 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003660 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3661 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3662 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3663
3664 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3665 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3666 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3667
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003668 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3669 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3670 checked in multiple backends.
3671
3672 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3673 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3674
3675 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3676 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3677 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3678 one fails.
3679
3680 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3681 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3682 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3683
3684 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3685 server's queue.
3686
3687 Example of a header received by the application server :
3688 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3689 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3690
3691 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3692
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003693http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3694 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003695 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003696 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003697 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003698 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3699 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003700 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3701 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003702 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3703 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3704 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003705 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003706 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003707 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003708 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003709 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003710 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003711 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003712 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003713 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003714 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3715
3716 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3717 no | yes | yes | yes
3718
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003719 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3720 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3721 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3722 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3723 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003724
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003725 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3726 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3727 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3728
3729 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003730 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3731 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3732 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3733 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003734
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003735 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3736 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3737 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003738 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3739 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003740 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3741 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3742 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3743 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3744 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003745 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003746 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3747 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003748
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003749 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3750 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3751 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3752 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3753 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3754
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003755 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3756 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3757 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003758 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3759 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003760
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003761 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3762 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3763 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3764 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3765 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3766 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3767 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3768 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3769
3770 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3771 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3772 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003773 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3774 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003775
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003776 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3777 <name>.
3778
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003779 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3780 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3781 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3782 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3783 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3784 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3785 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3786 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3787
3788 Example:
3789
3790 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3791
3792 applied to:
3793
3794 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3795
3796 outputs:
3797
3798 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3799
3800 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3801
3802 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3803 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3804 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3805 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3806 header.
3807
3808 Example:
3809
3810 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3811
3812 applied to:
3813
3814 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3815
3816 outputs:
3817
3818 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3819
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003820 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3821 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3822 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3823 it.
3824
3825 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3826 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3827 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3828 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3829 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3830 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3831
3832 Example :
3833 # prepend the host name before the path
3834 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3835
3836 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3837 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3838 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3839 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3840 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3841 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3842 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3843 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3844
3845 Example :
3846 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3847 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3848
3849 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3850 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3851 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3852 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3853 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3854 "set-query".
3855
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003856 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3857 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3858 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3859 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3860 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3861 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3862 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3863 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3864
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003865 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3866 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3867 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3868 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3869 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3870 another equipment.
3871
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003872 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3873 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3874 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3875 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3876 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3877 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3878 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3879 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3880
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003881 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3882 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3883 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3884 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3885 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3886 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3887 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3888 admin privileges.
3889
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003890 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3891 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3892 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3893 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3894 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3895 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3896 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3897 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3898
3899 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3900 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3901 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3902 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3903 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3904 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3905
3906 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3907 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3908 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3909 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3910 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3911 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3912
3913 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3914 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3915 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3916 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3917 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3918 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3919 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3920 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3921 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3922
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003923 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003924 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3925 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3926 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3927 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3928 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3929 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3930 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3931 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3932 request header" for more information.
3933
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003934 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3935 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3936 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3937 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003938 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3939 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003940
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003941 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3942 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3943 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3944 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3945 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3946 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3947 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3948 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3949 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3950 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3951 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3952 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3953
3954 These actions take one or two arguments :
3955 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3956 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3957 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3958 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3959
3960 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3961 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3962 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3963 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3964
3965 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3966 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3967 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3968 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3969 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3970 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3971 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3972 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3973
3974 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3975 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3976 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3977 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3978 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3979
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003980 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3981 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3982 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3983 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3984 continues.
3985
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003986 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3987 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3988 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3989 the actions evaluation continues.
3990
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003991 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3992 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3993 inline.
3994
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003995 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3996 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003997 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003998 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3999 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004000 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004001 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004002 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004003 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4004 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004005 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004006 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004007 and '_'.
4008
4009 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4010 followed by some converters.
4011
4012 Example:
4013
4014 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4015
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004016 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4017 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4018
4019 Example:
4020
4021 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4022
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004023 - set-src <expr> :
4024 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4025 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4026 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4027 source IP for privacy.
4028
4029 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4030 followed by some converters.
4031
4032 Example:
4033
4034 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4035 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4036
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004037 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4038 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004039
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004040 - set-src-port <expr> :
4041 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4042 expression.
4043
4044 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4045 followed by some converters.
4046
4047 Example:
4048
4049 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4050 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4051
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004052 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4053 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4054 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004055
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004056 - set-dst <expr> :
4057 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4058 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4059 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4060 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4061 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4062
4063 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4064 followed by some converters.
4065
4066 Example:
4067
4068 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4069 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4070
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004071 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4072 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4073
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004074 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4075 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4076 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4077 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4078
4079 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4080 followed by some converters.
4081
4082 Example:
4083
4084 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4085 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4086
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004087 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4088 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4089 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4090
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004091 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4092 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4093 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4094 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4095 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4096 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4097 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4098 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4099 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4100 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4101 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4102 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4103 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4104 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4105 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4106 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4107
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004108 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4109
4110 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4111 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004112 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4113 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4114
4115 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4116 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4117 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4118 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004119
4120 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004121 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4122 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4123 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004124
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004125 http-request allow if nagios
4126 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4127 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4128 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004129
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004130 Example:
4131 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004132 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004133
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004134 Example:
4135 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4136 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004137 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004138 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4139 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4140 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4141 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4142 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4143 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4144
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004145 Example:
4146 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4147 acl add path /addacl
4148 acl del path /delacl
4149
4150 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4151
4152 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4153 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4154
4155 Example:
4156 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4157 acl setmap path /setmap
4158 acl delmap path /delmap
4159
4160 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4161
4162 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4163 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4164
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004165 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4166 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004167
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004168http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004169 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004170 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004171 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4172 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004173 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004174 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4175 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4176 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4177 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004178 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004179 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004180 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004181 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004182 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004183 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004184 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004185 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004186 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004187 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4188
4189 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4190 no | yes | yes | yes
4191
4192 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4193 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4194 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4195 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4196 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4197 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4198
4199 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4200 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4201 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4202 current section.
4203
4204 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4205 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4206 rules are evaluated.
4207
4208 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4209 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4210 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4211 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4212 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4213 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4214 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4215
4216 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4217 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4218 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4219 external users.
4220
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004221 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4222 <name>.
4223
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004224 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4225 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4226 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4227 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4228 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4229 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4230 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4231 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4232
4233 Example:
4234
4235 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4236
4237 applied to:
4238
4239 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4240
4241 outputs:
4242
4243 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4244
4245 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4246
4247 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4248 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4249 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4250 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4251 header.
4252
4253 Example:
4254
4255 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4256
4257 applied to:
4258
4259 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4260
4261 outputs:
4262
4263 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4264
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004265 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004266 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4267 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4268 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004269
4270 Example:
4271
4272 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4273 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004274 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4275 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004276
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004277 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4278 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4279 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4280 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4281 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4282 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4283 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4284 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4285
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004286 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4287 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4288 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4289 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4290 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4291 another equipment.
4292
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004293 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4294 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4295 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4296 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4297 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4298 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4299 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4300 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4301
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004302 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4303 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4304 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4305 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4306 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4307 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4308 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4309 admin privileges.
4310
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004311 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4312 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4313 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4314 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4315 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4316 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4317 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4318 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4319
4320 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4321 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4322 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4323 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4324 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4325 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4326
4327 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4328 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4329 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4330 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4331 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4332 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4333
4334 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4335 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4336 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4337 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4338 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4339 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4340 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4341 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4342 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4343
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004344 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4345 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4346 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4347 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4348 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4349 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4350 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4351 response header" for more information.
4352
4353 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4354 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4355 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4356 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4357 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004358 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4359 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004360
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004361 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4362 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4363 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4364 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4365 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4366 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4367
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004368 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4369 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4370 inline.
4371
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004372 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4373 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004374 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004375 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4376 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004377 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004378 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004379 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004380 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4381 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004382 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004383 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4384 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004385
4386 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4387 followed by some converters.
4388
4389 Example:
4390
4391 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4392
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004393 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4394 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4395
4396 Example:
4397
4398 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4399
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004400 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4401 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4402 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4403 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4404 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4405 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4406 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4407
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004408 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4409 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4410 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4411 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4412 continues.
4413
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004414 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4415 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4416 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4417 the actions evaluation continues.
4418
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004419 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4420 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4421 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4422 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4423 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4424 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4425 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4426 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4427 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4428 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4429 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4430 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4431 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4432 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4433 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4434 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4435
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004436 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4437
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004438 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004439 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4440 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004441 rules.
4442
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004443 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4444 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4445 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4446 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4447
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004448 Example:
4449 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4450
4451 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4452
4453 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4454 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4455
4456 Example:
4457 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4458
4459 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4460
4461 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4462 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4463
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004464 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4465 ACL usage.
4466
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004467
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004468http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4469 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4470
4471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4472 yes | no | yes | yes
4473
4474 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4475 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4476 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4477 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4478 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4479 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4480
4481 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4482
4483 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4484 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4485 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4486 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4487 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4488 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4489 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4490 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4491 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4492 not checking any request past the first one.
4493
4494 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4495 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4496 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4497 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4498 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4499 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4500 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4501
4502 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4503 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4504 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4505 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4506 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4507 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4508 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4509 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4510 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4511 downsides of rare connection failures.
4512
4513 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4514 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4515 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4516 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4517 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4518 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4519 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4520 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4521 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4522 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4523 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4524 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4525
4526 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4527 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4528 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4529 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4530
4531 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4532 and are never shared ;
4533
4534 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4535 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4536 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4537 and are never shared ;
4538
4539 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4540 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4541 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4542
4543 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4544 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4545 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4546
4547 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4548
4549
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004550http-send-name-header [<header>]
4551 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4552
4553 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4554 yes | no | yes | yes
4555
4556 Arguments :
4557
4558 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4559
4560 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4561 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4562 is added with the header string proved.
4563
4564 See also : "server"
4565
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004566id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004567 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4569 no | yes | yes | yes
4570 Arguments : none
4571
4572 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4573 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4574 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004575
4576
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004577ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4578 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4579 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4580 no | yes | yes | yes
4581
4582 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4583 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4584 and running).
4585
4586 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4587 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4588 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004589 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004590 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4591
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004592 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4593 "unless" condition is met.
4594
4595 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4596
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004597load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4598 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4599 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4600 yes | no | yes | yes
4601
4602 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4603 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4604 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4605 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4606 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4607 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4608 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4609 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4610
4611 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4612 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004613 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004614
4615 Arguments:
4616 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4617 named "server-state-file".
4618
4619 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4620 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4621 name is used as a file name.
4622
4623 none don't load any stat for this backend
4624
4625 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004626 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4627 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4628 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4629 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4630 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004631
4632 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4633 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4634
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004635 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004636
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004637 global
4638 stats socket /tmp/socket
4639 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004640
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004641 defaults
4642 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004643
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004644 backend bk
4645 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4646 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004647
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004648
4649 Then one can run :
4650
4651 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4652
4653 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4654
4655 1
4656 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4657 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4658 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4659
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004660 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004661
4662 global
4663 stats socket /tmp/socket
4664 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4665
4666 defaults
4667 load-server-state-from-file local
4668
4669 backend bk
4670 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4671 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4672
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004673
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004674 Then one can run :
4675
4676 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4677
4678 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4679
4680 1
4681 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4682 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4683 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4684
4685 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4686 "show servers state"
4687
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004688
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004689log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004690log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004691no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004692 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4694 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004695
4696 Prefix :
4697 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4698 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4699 prefix does not allow arguments.
4700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701 Arguments :
4702 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4703 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4704 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4705 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4706 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4707 parameter.
4708
4709 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4710 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4711
4712 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4713 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4714 standard syslog port).
4715
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004716 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4717 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4718 standard syslog port).
4719
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004720 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4721 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4722 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4723 appropriately writeable).
4724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004725 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4726 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004727
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004728 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4729 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4730 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4731 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4732 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4733 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4734 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4735 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4736 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4737 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4738 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4739
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004740 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4741
4742 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4743 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4744 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4745
4746 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4747 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4748 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004749 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4750 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4751 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4752 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4753 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004754
4755 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4756
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004757 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4758 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4759 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004760
4761 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4762 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4763 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4764 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4765
4766 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4767 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004768
4769 Example :
4770 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004771 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4772 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004773 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004774
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004775
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004776log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004777 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4778 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4779 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004780
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004781 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4782 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4783 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4784 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4785 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004786
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004787 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4788 "option httplog" directives.
4789
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004790log-format-sd <string>
4791 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4792 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 yes | yes | yes | no
4794
4795 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4796 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4797 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4798 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4799 which covers the log format string in depth.
4800
4801 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4802 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4803
4804 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4805 log format to "rfc5424".
4806
4807 Example :
4808 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4809
4810
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004811log-tag <string>
4812 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4814 yes | yes | yes | yes
4815
4816 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4817 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4818 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4819 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4820 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4821 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4822 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4823 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4824 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004825
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004826max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4827 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4829 yes | no | yes | yes
4830
4831 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4832 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4833 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4834 servers.
4835
4836 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4837 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4838 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4839 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4840 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4841 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4842 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4843 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4844 picking a different server.
4845
4846 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4847 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4848 even if they have to be queued.
4849
4850 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4851 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4852
4853
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004854maxconn <conns>
4855 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4856 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4857 yes | yes | yes | no
4858 Arguments :
4859 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4860 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4861 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4862 closes.
4863
4864 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4865 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4866 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4867 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004868 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4869 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4870 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4871 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004872
4873 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4874 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4875 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4876
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004877 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4878
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4880
4881
4882mode { tcp|http|health }
4883 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4885 yes | yes | yes | yes
4886 Arguments :
4887 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4888 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4889 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4890 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4891
4892 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4893 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4894 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4895 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4896 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4897
4898 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004899 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4900 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4901 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4902 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4903 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4904 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4905 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004907 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4908 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4909 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004911 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004912 defaults http_instances
4913 mode http
4914
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004915 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004917
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004918monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004919 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004920 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4921 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004922 Arguments :
4923 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4924 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004925 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004926 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4927 backend and its backup.
4928
4929 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4930 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4931 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4932 servers in a list of backends.
4933
4934 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4935 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4936 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4937 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4938 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4939 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4940 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004941 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4942 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004943
4944 Example:
4945 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004946 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004947 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4948 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4949 monitor-uri /site_alive
4950 monitor fail if site_dead
4951
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004952 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004953
4954
4955monitor-net <source>
4956 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4958 yes | yes | yes | no
4959 Arguments :
4960 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4961 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4962 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4963 followed by a mask.
4964
4965 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4966 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004967 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004968 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4969
4970 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4971 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4972 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4973 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004974 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4975 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4976 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004977
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004978 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4979 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4980 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4981 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4982 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4983 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004984
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004985 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4986 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004987
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004988 Example :
4989 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4990 frontend www
4991 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4992
4993 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4994
4995
4996monitor-uri <uri>
4997 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4999 yes | yes | yes | no
5000 Arguments :
5001 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5002 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5003
5004 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5005 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5006 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5007 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5008 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5009 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5010 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5011 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5012
5013 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5014 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5015 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5016 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5017 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5018 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5019
5020 Example :
5021 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5022 frontend www
5023 mode http
5024 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5025
5026 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5027
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005028
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005029option abortonclose
5030no option abortonclose
5031 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5033 yes | no | yes | yes
5034 Arguments : none
5035
5036 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5037 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5038 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5039 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005040 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005041 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5042 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5043 encountered while delivering the response.
5044
5045 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5046 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5047 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5048 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5049 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5050 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005051 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005052 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005053 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005054 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5055 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5056 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5057
5058 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5059 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5060 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5061 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5062 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5063 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5064 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5065 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005066 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005067
5068 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5069 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5070
5071 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5072
5073
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005074option accept-invalid-http-request
5075no option accept-invalid-http-request
5076 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5078 yes | yes | yes | no
5079 Arguments : none
5080
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005081 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005082 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5083 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5084 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5085 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5086 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5087 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5088 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005089 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5090 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5091 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5092 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5093 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005094 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005095 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5096 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5097 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005098
5099 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5100 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5101 been confirmed.
5102
5103 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5104 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005105 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5106 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005107 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5108
5109 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5110 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5111
5112 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5113 stats socket.
5114
5115
5116option accept-invalid-http-response
5117no option accept-invalid-http-response
5118 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5120 yes | no | yes | yes
5121 Arguments : none
5122
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005123 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005124 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5125 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5126 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5127 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5128 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5129 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5130 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005131 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5132 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5133 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005134
5135 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5136 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5137 been confirmed.
5138
5139 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5140 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5141 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5142 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5143
5144 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5145 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5146
5147 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5148 stats socket.
5149
5150
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005151option allbackups
5152no option allbackups
5153 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5155 yes | no | yes | yes
5156 Arguments : none
5157
5158 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5159 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5160 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5161 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5162 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5163 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5164 order between the backup servers anymore.
5165
5166 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5167 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5168
5169 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5170 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5171
5172
5173option checkcache
5174no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005175 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005176 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5177 yes | no | yes | yes
5178 Arguments : none
5179
5180 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5181 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005182 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005183 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5184 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005185 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005186
5187 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005188 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005189 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005190 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5191 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005192 to the client are :
5193 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005194 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005195 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005196 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5197 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5198 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5199 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5200 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5201 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5202 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5203 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5204 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5205 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5206 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5207
5208 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005209 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005210 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005211 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005212 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5213
5214 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5215 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005216 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005217 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5218
5219 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5220 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5221
5222
5223option clitcpka
5224no option clitcpka
5225 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5227 yes | yes | yes | no
5228 Arguments : none
5229
5230 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5231 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5232 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5233 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5234
5235 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5236 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5237 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5238 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5239
5240 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5241 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5242 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5243 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5244 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5245
5246 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5247
5248 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5249 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5250 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5251
5252 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5253 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5254
5255 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5256
5257
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005258option contstats
5259 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5261 yes | yes | yes | no
5262 Arguments : none
5263
5264 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5265 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5266 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5267 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005268 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5269 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5270 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5271 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5272 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005273
5274
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005275option dontlog-normal
5276no option dontlog-normal
5277 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5278 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5279 yes | yes | yes | no
5280 Arguments : none
5281
5282 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5283 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5284 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5285 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5286 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5287 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5288 logged.
5289
5290 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5291 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5292 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5293
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005294 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005295 logging.
5296
5297
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005298option dontlognull
5299no option dontlognull
5300 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5301 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5302 yes | yes | yes | no
5303 Arguments : none
5304
5305 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5306 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5307 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5308 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5309 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5310 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005311 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5312 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5313 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005314
5315 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5316 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5317 would not be logged.
5318
5319 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5320 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5321
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005322 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5323 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005324
5325
5326option forceclose
5327no option forceclose
5328 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005330 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005331 Arguments : none
5332
5333 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5334 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5335 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5336 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5337 global session times in the logs.
5338
5339 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005340 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005341 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005342
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005343 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5344 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5345 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5346
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005347 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5348 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005349
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5352
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005353 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005354
5355
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005356option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005357 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5359 yes | yes | yes | yes
5360 Arguments :
5361 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5362 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005363 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005364 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005365
5366 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5367 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5368 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5369 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5370 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5371 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5372 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005373 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5374 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5375 possible that the client has already brought one.
5376
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005377 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005378 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005379 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5380 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005381 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5382 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005383
5384 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5385 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5386 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5387 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5388 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5389 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5390 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5391
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005392 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5393 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5394 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5395 are under the control of the end-user.
5396
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005397 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005398 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5399 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005400 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5401 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5402 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005403
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005404 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005405 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5406 frontend www
5407 mode http
5408 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5409
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005410 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5411 backend www
5412 mode http
5413 option forwardfor header X-Client
5414
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005415 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005416 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005417
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005418
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005419option http-buffer-request
5420no option http-buffer-request
5421 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5422 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5423 yes | yes | yes | yes
5424 Arguments : none
5425
5426 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5427 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5428 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5429 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5430 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5431 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5432 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5433 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005434 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005435 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5436 default.
5437
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005438 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005439
5440
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005441option http-ignore-probes
5442no option http-ignore-probes
5443 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | yes | yes | no
5446 Arguments : none
5447
5448 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5449 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5450 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5451 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5452 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5453 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5454 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5455 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5456 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5457 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5458 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5459 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5460
5461 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5462 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5463 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5464 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5465 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5466 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5467 are often the only way to detect them.
5468
5469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5471
5472 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5473
5474
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005475option http-keep-alive
5476no option http-keep-alive
5477 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5479 yes | yes | yes | yes
5480 Arguments : none
5481
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005482 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5483 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5484 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5485 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5486 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5487 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5488 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5489
5490 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5491 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005492 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5493 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5494 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5495 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5496 situations where this option may be useful :
5497
5498 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5499 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5500
5501 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5502 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5503
5504 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5505 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5506 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5507 request.
5508
5509 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5510 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005511 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5512 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5513 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005514
5515 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5516 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5517
5518 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5519 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5520 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5521 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5522 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5523 not set.
5524
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005525 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5526 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005527 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005528 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005529
5530 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005531 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5532 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005533
5534
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005535option http-no-delay
5536no option http-no-delay
5537 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5538 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5539 yes | yes | yes | yes
5540 Arguments : none
5541
5542 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5543 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5544 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5545 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5546 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5547 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5548 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5549 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5550 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5551 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5552 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5553 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5554 affected.
5555
5556 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5557 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5558 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5559 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5560 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5561 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5562 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5563 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5564 latency environments.
5565
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005566 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5567
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005568
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005569option http-pretend-keepalive
5570no option http-pretend-keepalive
5571 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5573 yes | yes | yes | yes
5574 Arguments : none
5575
5576 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5577 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5578 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5579 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5580 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5581 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5582 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5583 consider the response complete.
5584
5585 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5586 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5587 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5588 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5589 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5590 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5591
5592 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5593 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5594 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5595 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5596 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5597 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5598 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5599
5600 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5601 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005602 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005603 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5604 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005605
5606 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5607 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5608
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005609 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5610 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005611
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005612
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005613option http-server-close
5614no option http-server-close
5615 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5617 yes | yes | yes | yes
5618 Arguments : none
5619
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005620 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5621 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5622 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5623 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5624 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5625 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5626 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5627 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5628 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5629 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5630 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5631 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5632 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5633 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5634 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5635 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005636
5637 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5638 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5639 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5640 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005641 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5642 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005643
5644 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5645 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005646 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5647 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005648 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5649 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005650
5651 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5652 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5653
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005654 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005655 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5656 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005657
5658
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005659option http-tunnel
5660no option http-tunnel
5661 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5663 yes | yes | yes | yes
5664 Arguments : none
5665
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005666 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5667 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5668 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5669 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5670 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5671 "option http-tunnel".
5672
5673 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005674 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005675 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5676 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5677 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5678 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5679 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5680 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5681 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005682
5683 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5684 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5685
5686 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5687 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5688 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5689
5690
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005691option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005692no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005693 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5695 yes | yes | yes | no
5696 Arguments : none
5697
5698 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5699 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5700 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5701 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5702 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5703 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5704 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5705
5706 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5707 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005708 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5709 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5710 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005711
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005712 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5713 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5714 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5715 front of an existing proxy.
5716
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005717 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5718
5719 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5720 http-server-close".
5721
5722
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005723option httpchk
5724option httpchk <uri>
5725option httpchk <method> <uri>
5726option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5727 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5729 yes | no | yes | yes
5730 Arguments :
5731 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5732 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5733 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5734 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5735 ones.
5736
5737 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5738 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5739 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5740
5741 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5742 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5743 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5744 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5745 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5746
5747 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5748 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5749 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5750 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5751 the lack of any response.
5752
5753 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5754
5755 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5756 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5757 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5758
5759 Examples :
5760 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5761 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5762 backend https_relay
5763 mode tcp
5764 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5765 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5766
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005767 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5768 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5769 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005770
5771
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005772option httpclose
5773no option httpclose
5774 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5776 yes | yes | yes | yes
5777 Arguments : none
5778
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005779 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5780 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5781 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5782 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005783 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005784 "option http-tunnel".
5785
5786 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5787 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5788 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5789 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5790 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5791 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5792 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5793 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005794
5795 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005796 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005797 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5798 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5799 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5800 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5801 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005802
5803 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5804 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005805 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5806 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005807 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5808 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005809
5810 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5811 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5812
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005813 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5814 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005815
5816
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005817option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005818 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5820 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005821 Arguments :
5822 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5823 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5824 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5825 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5826 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005827
5828 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5829 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5830 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5831 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5832 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5833 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5834 ports.
5835
5836 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5837
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005838 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5839 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005840
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005841 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005843 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005844
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005845
5846option http_proxy
5847no option http_proxy
5848 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5850 yes | yes | yes | yes
5851 Arguments : none
5852
5853 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5854 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5855 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5856 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5857 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5858
5859 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5860 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005861 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5862 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005863
5864 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5865 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5866
5867 Example :
5868 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5869 backend direct_forward
5870 option httpclose
5871 option http_proxy
5872
5873 See also : "option httpclose"
5874
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005875
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005876option independent-streams
5877no option independent-streams
5878 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5880 yes | yes | yes | yes
5881 Arguments : none
5882
5883 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5884 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5885 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5886 receive data or not.
5887
5888 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5889 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5890 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5891 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5892 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5893 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5894 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5895 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5896 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5897 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5898 socket buffers.
5899
5900 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5901 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5902 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5903 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5904 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5905
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005906 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005907 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5908 deprecated.
5909
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005910 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005911
5912
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005913option ldap-check
5914 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5916 yes | no | yes | yes
5917 Arguments : none
5918
5919 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5920 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5921 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5922 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5923
5924 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5925 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5926
5927 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5928 configure it.
5929
5930 Example :
5931 option ldap-check
5932
5933 See also : "option httpchk"
5934
5935
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005936option external-check
5937 Use external processes for server health checks
5938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5939 yes | no | yes | yes
5940
5941 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5942 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5943 command".
5944
5945 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5946
5947 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5948
5949
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005950option log-health-checks
5951no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005952 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5954 yes | no | yes | yes
5955 Arguments : none
5956
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005957 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5958 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5959 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005960
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005961 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5962 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5963 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5964 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5965 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5966
5967 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5968 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005969
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005970 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5971 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5972 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005973
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005974
5975option log-separate-errors
5976no option log-separate-errors
5977 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5979 yes | yes | yes | no
5980 Arguments : none
5981
5982 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5983 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5984 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5985 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5986 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5987 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5988 provides very important information.
5989
5990 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5991 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5992 error logs.
5993
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005994 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005995 logging.
5996
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005997
5998option logasap
5999no option logasap
6000 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6001 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6002 yes | yes | yes | no
6003 Arguments : none
6004
6005 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6006 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6007 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6008 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6009 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6010 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6011 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006012 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006013 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6014 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6015
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006016 Examples :
6017 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6018 mode http
6019 option httplog
6020 option logasap
6021 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6022
6023 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6024 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6025 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6026 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6027
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006028 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006029 logging.
6030
6031
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006032option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006033 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6035 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006036 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006037 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6038 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006039 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006040
6041 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6042 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6043 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6044 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6045 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6046 in the MySQL table, like this :
6047
6048 USE mysql;
6049 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6050 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6051
6052 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6053 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6054 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6055 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6056 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6057 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6058 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6059 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6060 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6061
6062 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6063 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006064
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006065 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006066
6067 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6068 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6069 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6070 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006071 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6072 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006073
6074 See also: "option httpchk"
6075
6076
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006077option nolinger
6078no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006079 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6081 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006082 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006083
6084 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6085 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6086 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6087 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6088 connections.
6089
6090 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6091 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6092 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6093 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6094 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6095 this too.
6096
6097 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6098 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6099 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6100
6101 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6102 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6103 for servers.
6104
6105 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6106 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6107
6108
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006109option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6110 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6112 yes | yes | yes | yes
6113 Arguments :
6114 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6115 matching <network>
6116 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6117 header name.
6118
6119 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6120 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6121 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6122 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6123 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6124 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6125 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6126 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6127 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6128 possible that the client has already brought one.
6129
6130 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6131 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6132 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6133 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6134 header and requires different one.
6135
6136 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6137 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6138 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6139 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6140 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6141 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6142 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6143
6144 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6145 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6146 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6147 both are defined.
6148
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006149 Examples :
6150 # Original Destination address
6151 frontend www
6152 mode http
6153 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6154
6155 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6156 backend www
6157 mode http
6158 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6159
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006160 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6161 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006162
6163
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006164option persist
6165no option persist
6166 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6167 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6168 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006169 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006170
6171 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6172 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6173 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6174 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6175 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6176 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6177 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6178 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6179 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6180 redirected to another valid server.
6181
6182 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6183 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6184
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006185 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006186
6187
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006188option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6189 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6190 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6191 yes | no | yes | yes
6192 Arguments :
6193 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6194 PostgreSQL server.
6195
6196 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6197 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6198 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6199 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6200
6201 See also: "option httpchk"
6202
6203
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006204option prefer-last-server
6205no option prefer-last-server
6206 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6207 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6208 yes | no | yes | yes
6209 Arguments : none
6210
6211 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6212 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6213 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6214 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6215 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6216 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6217 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6218 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6219 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006220 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6221 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6222 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6223 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6224 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6225 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6226 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006227
6228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6230
6231 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6232
6233
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006234option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006235option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006236no option redispatch
6237 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6238 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6239 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006240 Arguments :
6241 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6242 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6243 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6244 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6245 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6246 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6247 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6248 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6249 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6250
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006251
6252 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6253 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6254 be able to access the service anymore.
6255
6256 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6257 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6258
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006259 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006260 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6261 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006262
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006263 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6264 "redisp" keywords.
6265
6266 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6267 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6268
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006269 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006270
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006271
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006272option redis-check
6273 Use redis health checks for server testing
6274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6275 yes | no | yes | yes
6276 Arguments : none
6277
6278 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6279 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6280 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6281 find the "+PONG" response message.
6282
6283 Example :
6284 option redis-check
6285
6286 See also : "option httpchk"
6287
6288
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006289option smtpchk
6290option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6291 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6293 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006294 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006295 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6296 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6297 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6298
6299 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6300 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6301 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6302
6303 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6304 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6305 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6306 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6307 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6308 dead server.
6309
6310 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6311 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6312 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6313 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6314
6315 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6316 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6317 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6318 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006319 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006320
6321 Example :
6322 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6323
6324 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006326
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006327option socket-stats
6328no option socket-stats
6329
6330 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6331 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6332 yes | yes | yes | no
6333
6334 Arguments : none
6335
6336
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006337option splice-auto
6338no option splice-auto
6339 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6341 yes | yes | yes | yes
6342 Arguments : none
6343
6344 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6345 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6346 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6347 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006348 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006349 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6350 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6351 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6352 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6353
6354 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6355 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6356 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6357 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6358 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6359 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6360 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6361 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6362 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6363 keyword.
6364
6365 Example :
6366 option splice-auto
6367
6368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6370
6371 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6372 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6373
6374
6375option splice-request
6376no option splice-request
6377 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6379 yes | yes | yes | yes
6380 Arguments : none
6381
6382 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006383 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006384 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6385 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6386 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6387 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6388
6389 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6390
6391 Example :
6392 option splice-request
6393
6394 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6395 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6396
6397 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6398 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6399
6400
6401option splice-response
6402no option splice-response
6403 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6404 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6405 yes | yes | yes | yes
6406 Arguments : none
6407
6408 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006409 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006410 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6411 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6412 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6413 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6414
6415 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6416
6417 Example :
6418 option splice-response
6419
6420 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6421 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6422
6423 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6424 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6425
6426
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006427option spop-check
6428 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6430 no | no | no | yes
6431 Arguments : none
6432
6433 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6434 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6435 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6436 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6437
6438 Example :
6439 option spop-check
6440
6441 See also : "option httpchk"
6442
6443
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006444option srvtcpka
6445no option srvtcpka
6446 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6448 yes | no | yes | yes
6449 Arguments : none
6450
6451 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6452 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6453 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6454 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6455
6456 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6457 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6458 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6459 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6460
6461 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6462 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6463 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6464 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6465 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6466
6467 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6468
6469 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6470 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6471 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6472
6473 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6474 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6475
6476 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6477
6478
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006479option ssl-hello-chk
6480 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6482 yes | no | yes | yes
6483 Arguments : none
6484
6485 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6486 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6487 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6488 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6489 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6490 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6491 hello message.
6492
6493 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6494 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6495 messages, which is appreciable.
6496
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006497 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6498 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6499 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006500
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006501 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6502
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006503
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006504option tcp-check
6505 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6506 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | no | yes | yes
6508
6509 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6510 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6511
6512 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6513 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6514 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6515
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006516 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006517 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6518 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6519 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6520 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6521 only.
6522
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006523 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006524 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6525 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6526 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6527 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6528
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006529 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006530 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6531 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006532 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006533 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6534 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6535 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6536 the respective protocols.
6537 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6538 analysed.
6539
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006540 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6541 script.
6542
6543 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6544 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6545 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6546 The "comment" is of course optional.
6547
6548
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006549 Examples :
6550 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6551 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006552 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006553
6554 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6555 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006556 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006557
6558 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6559 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006560 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006561 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006562 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006563 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006564 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006565 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006566 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6567 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006568 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006569 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6570 tcp-check expect string +OK
6571
6572 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6573 (send many headers before analyzing)
6574 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006575 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006576 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6577 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6578 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6579 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006580 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006581
6582
6583 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6584
6585
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006586option tcp-smart-accept
6587no option tcp-smart-accept
6588 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6589 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6590 yes | yes | yes | no
6591 Arguments : none
6592
6593 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6594 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6595 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6596 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6597 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6598 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6599
6600 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6601 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6602 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6603 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6604
6605 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6606 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6607 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6608 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6609
6610 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6611 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6612 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6613
6614 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6615 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6616 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6617
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006618 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6619
6620
6621option tcp-smart-connect
6622no option tcp-smart-connect
6623 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6624 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6625 yes | no | yes | yes
6626 Arguments : none
6627
6628 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6629 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6630 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6631 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6632 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6633
6634 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6635 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6636 complex.
6637
6638 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6639 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6640 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6641
6642 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6643 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6644
6645 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6646
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006647
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006648option tcpka
6649 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6650 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6651 yes | yes | yes | yes
6652 Arguments : none
6653
6654 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6655 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6656 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6657 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6658
6659 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6660 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6661 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6662 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6663
6664 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6665 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6666 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6667 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6668 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6669
6670 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6671
6672 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6673 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6674 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6675 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6676 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6677 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6678 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6679 backends.
6680
6681 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6682
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006683
6684option tcplog
6685 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6687 yes | yes | yes | yes
6688 Arguments : none
6689
6690 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6691 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6692 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6693 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6694 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6695 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6696 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6697 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6698
6699 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6700
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006701 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006703 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006704
6705
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006706option transparent
6707no option transparent
6708 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006710 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006711 Arguments : none
6712
6713 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6714 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6715 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6716 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6717 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6718 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6719 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6720 appropriate server.
6721
6722 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6723 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6724
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006725 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006726 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006727
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006728
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006729external-check command <command>
6730 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6732 yes | no | yes | yes
6733
6734 Arguments :
6735 <command> is the external command to run
6736
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006737 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6738
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006739 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006740
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006741 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6742 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6743 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6744 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6745 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6746 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006747
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006748 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6749
6750 Environment variables :
6751 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6752 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6753
6754 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6755
6756 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6757
6758 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6759 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6760 for a UNIX socket).
6761
6762 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6763
6764 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6765
6766 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6767
6768 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6769
6770 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6771
6772 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6773 socket).
6774
6775 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6776 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6777
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006778 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6779 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6780 failed.
6781
6782 Example :
6783 external-check command /bin/true
6784
6785 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6786
6787
6788external-check path <path>
6789 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6791 yes | no | yes | yes
6792
6793 Arguments :
6794 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6795
6796 The default path is "".
6797
6798 Example :
6799 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6800
6801 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6802 "external-check command"
6803
6804
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006805persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006806persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006807 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6809 yes | no | yes | yes
6810 Arguments :
6811 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006812 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6813 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006814
6815 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6816 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6817 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6818 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6819 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6820 forwarded to this server.
6821
6822 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6823 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6824 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006825 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006826 a single "listen" section.
6827
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006828 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6829 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6830 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6831
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006832 Example :
6833 listen tse-farm
6834 bind :3389
6835 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6836 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6837 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6838 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6839 persist rdp-cookie
6840 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006841 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006842 balance rdp-cookie
6843 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6844 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6845
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006846 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6847 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006848
6849
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006850rate-limit sessions <rate>
6851 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6853 yes | yes | yes | no
6854 Arguments :
6855 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6856 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6857
6858 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6859 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6860 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6861 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6862 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6863 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6864
6865 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6866 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6867 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6868 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6869
6870 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6871 listen smtp
6872 mode tcp
6873 bind :25
6874 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006875 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006876
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006877 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6878 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6879 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006880
6881 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6882
6883
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006884redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6885redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6886redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006887 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6889 no | yes | yes | yes
6890
6891 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006892 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006893
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006894 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006895 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006896 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6897 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6898 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006899
6900 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6901 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6902 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6903 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6904 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006905 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6906 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6907 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6908 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006909
6910 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6911 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6912 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6913 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6914 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6915 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006916 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006917 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006918 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6919 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6920 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006921
6922 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006923 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6924 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6925 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006926 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006927 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6928 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6929 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6930 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006931
6932 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6933 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6934
6935 - "drop-query"
6936 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6937 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6938 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6939 with a location-type redirect.
6940
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006941 - "append-slash"
6942 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6943 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6944 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6945 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6946
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006947 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6948 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6949 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6950 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6951 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6952 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6953 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6954
6955 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6956 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6957 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6958 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6959 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6960 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6961 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006962
6963 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6964 acl clear dst_port 80
6965 acl secure dst_port 8080
6966 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006967 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006968 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006969 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6970
6971 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006972 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6973 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6974 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006975 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006976
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006977 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6978 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6979 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6980
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006981 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006982 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006983
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006984 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006985 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6986 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6987 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006989 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006990
6991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006992redisp (deprecated)
6993redispatch (deprecated)
6994 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6995 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6996 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006997 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006998
6999 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7000 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7001 be able to access the service anymore.
7002
7003 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7004 redistribute them to a working server.
7005
7006 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7007 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7008 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007010 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7011 "option redispatch" instead.
7012
7013 See also : "option redispatch"
7014
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007015
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007016reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007017 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7019 no | yes | yes | yes
7020 Arguments :
7021 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7022 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007023 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007024
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007025 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7026 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7027
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007028 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7029 the last header of an HTTP request.
7030
7031 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7032 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7033 responses.
7034
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007035 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7036 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7037 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7038
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007039 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7040 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007041
7042
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007043reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7044reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007045 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7047 no | yes | yes | yes
7048 Arguments :
7049 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7050 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7051 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7052 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7053 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7054 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7055 ignores case.
7056
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007057 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7058 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7059
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007060 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7061 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7062 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7063 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007064 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007065
7066 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7067 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7068
7069 Example :
7070 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7071 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7072 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7073
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007074 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7075 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007076
7077
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007078reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7079reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007080 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7082 no | yes | yes | yes
7083 Arguments :
7084 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7085 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7086 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7087 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7088 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7089 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7090
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007091 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7092 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7093
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007094 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7095 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7096 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7097 next servers.
7098
7099 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7100 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7101 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7102
7103 Example :
7104 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7105 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7106 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7107
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007108 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7109 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007110
7111
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007112reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7113reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007114 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7115 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7116 no | yes | yes | yes
7117 Arguments :
7118 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7119 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7120 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7121 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7122 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7123 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7124 case.
7125
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007126 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7127 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7128
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7130 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7131 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7132 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007133 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007134
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007135 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007136 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007137 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007138
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007139 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7140 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7141
7142 Example :
7143 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7144 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7145 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7146
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007147 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7148 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007149
7150
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007151reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7152reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007153 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7155 no | yes | yes | yes
7156 Arguments :
7157 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7158 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7159 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7160 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7161 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7162 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7163 case.
7164
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007165 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7166 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7167
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007168 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7169 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7170 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7171 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7172
7173 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7174 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7175
7176 Example :
7177 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7178 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7179 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7180 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7181
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007182 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7183 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007184
7185
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007186reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7187reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007188 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7190 no | yes | yes | yes
7191 Arguments :
7192 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7193 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7194 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7195 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7196 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7197 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7198
7199 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7200 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7201 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7202 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007203 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007204
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007205 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7206 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7207
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007208 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7209 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7210 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7211
7212 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7213 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7214 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7215 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7216 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7217
7218 Example :
7219 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007220 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007221 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7222 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7223
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007224 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7225 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007226
7227
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007228reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7229reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007230 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7232 no | yes | yes | yes
7233 Arguments :
7234 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7235 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7236 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7237 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7238 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7239 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7240 ignores case.
7241
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007242 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7243 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7244
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007245 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7246 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007247 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7248 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7249 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007250 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7251 not set.
7252
7253 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7254 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7255 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7256 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7257 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7258
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007259 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007260 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7261 # block all others.
7262 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7263 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7264
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007265 # block bad guys
7266 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7267 reqitarpit . if badguys
7268
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007269 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7270 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007271
7272
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007273retries <value>
7274 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7276 yes | no | yes | yes
7277 Arguments :
7278 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7279 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7280 default value is 3.
7281
7282 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7283 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7284 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7285
7286 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007287 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7288 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007289
7290 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7291 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7292
7293 See also : "option redispatch"
7294
7295
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007296rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007297 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7299 no | yes | yes | yes
7300 Arguments :
7301 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7302 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007303 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007304
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007305 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7306 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7307
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007308 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7309 the last header of an HTTP response.
7310
7311 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7312 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7313 responses.
7314
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007315 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7316 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007317
7318
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007319rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7320rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007321 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7323 no | yes | yes | yes
7324 Arguments :
7325 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7326 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7327 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7328 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7329 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7330 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7331 ignores case.
7332
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007333 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7334 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7335
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007336 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7337 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007338 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007339 client.
7340
7341 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7342 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7343 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7344
7345 Example :
7346 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007347 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007348
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007349 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7350 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007351
7352
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007353rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7354rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007355 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7357 no | yes | yes | yes
7358 Arguments :
7359 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7360 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7361 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7362 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7363 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7364 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7365 ignores case.
7366
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007367 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7368 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7369
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007370 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7371 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7372 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7373 case-sensitive.
7374
7375 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007376 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7377 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7378 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007379
7380 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7381 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7382
7383 Example :
7384 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7385 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7386
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007387 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7388 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007389
7390
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007391rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7392rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007393 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7395 no | yes | yes | yes
7396 Arguments :
7397 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7398 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7399 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7400 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7401 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7402 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7403 ignores case.
7404
7405 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7406 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7407 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7408 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007409 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007410
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007411 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7412 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7413
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007414 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7415 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7416 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7417
7418 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7419 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7420 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7421 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7422 are not case-sensitive.
7423
7424 Example :
7425 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7426 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7427
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007428 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7429 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007430
7431
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007432server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007433 Declare a server in a backend
7434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7435 no | no | yes | yes
7436 Arguments :
7437 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007438 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007439 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007440
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007441 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7442 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7443 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7444 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007445 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7446 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7447 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7448 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7449 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007450 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7451 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7452 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7453 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7454 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7455 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7456 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007457 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007458 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7459 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007460 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7461 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007462
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007463 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007464 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7465 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7466 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7467 adding this value to the client's port.
7468
7469 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7470 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007471 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007472
7473 Examples :
7474 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7475 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007476 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007477 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7478 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7479 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007480
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007481 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7482 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7483 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7484 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7485 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7486
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007487 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7488 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007489
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007490server-state-file-name [<file>]
7491 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7492 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7493 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7494 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7495 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7496 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7497
7498 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7499 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7500
7501 global
7502 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7503
7504 backend bk
7505 load-server-state-from-file
7506
7507 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7508 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007509
7510source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007511source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007512source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007513 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7514 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7515 yes | no | yes | yes
7516 Arguments :
7517 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7518 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007519
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007520 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007521 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7522 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7523 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7524 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7525 supported prefixes are :
7526 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7527 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7528 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007529 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007530 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7531 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007532
7533 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7534 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007535 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7536 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7537 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007538
7539 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7540 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7541 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7542 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7543 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7544 <addr>.
7545
7546 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7547 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7548 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7549 port.
7550
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007551 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7552 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7553 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7554 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007555 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007556 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7557 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7558 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7559 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7560 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7561 HTTP header.
7562
7563 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7564 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007565 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007566 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7567 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7568 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7569 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7570 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7571 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7572 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7573
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007574 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7575 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7576 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7577 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7578 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7579 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7580
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007581 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7582 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7583 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7584 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7585
7586 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7587 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7588 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7589 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7590 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7591 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7592
7593 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7594 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7595 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7596 there are two methods :
7597
7598 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7599 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7600 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7601 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7602 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7603 of the client ranges may be used.
7604
7605 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7606 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7607 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7608 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7609 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7610 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7611 same session.
7612
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007613 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7614 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7615 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007616 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007617
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007618 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7619
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007620 Examples :
7621 backend private
7622 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7623 source 192.168.1.200
7624
7625 backend transparent_ssl1
7626 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7627 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7628
7629 backend transparent_ssl2
7630 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7631 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7632 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7633
7634 backend transparent_ssl3
7635 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7636 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7637 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7638
7639 backend transparent_smtp
7640 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7641 # with Tproxy version 4.
7642 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7643
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007644 backend transparent_http
7645 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7646 # proxy.
7647 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7648
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007649 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007650 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7651
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007652
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007653srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7654 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7655 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7656 yes | no | yes | yes
7657 Arguments :
7658 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7659 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7660 as explained at the top of this document.
7661
7662 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7663 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7664 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7665 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7666 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7667 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7668 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7669
7670 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7671 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7672 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7673 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7674 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007675 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007676 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007677 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007678
7679 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7680 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7681 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7682 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7683 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7684 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7685
7686 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7687 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7688
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007689 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7690 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007691
7692
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007693stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7694 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007696 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007697
7698 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7699 matched.
7700
7701 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7702 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7703
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007704 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7705 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7706 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7707
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007708 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7709 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7710 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7711 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007712
7713 Example :
7714 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7715 backend stats_localhost
7716 stats enable
7717 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7718
7719 Example :
7720 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7721 backend stats_auth
7722 stats enable
7723 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7724 stats admin if TRUE
7725
7726 Example :
7727 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7728 userlist stats-auth
7729 group admin users admin
7730 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7731 group readonly users haproxy
7732 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7733
7734 backend stats_auth
7735 stats enable
7736 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7737 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7738 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7739 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7740
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007741 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7742 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7743 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007744
7745
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007746stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7747 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007749 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007750 Arguments :
7751 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7752
7753 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7754
7755 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7756 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7757 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7758 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7759 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7760 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7761
7762 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7763 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7764 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007765 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007766
7767 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7768 report using "stats scope".
7769
7770 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7771 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7772 unobvious parameters.
7773
7774 Example :
7775 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7776 backend public_www
7777 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7778 stats enable
7779 stats hide-version
7780 stats scope .
7781 stats uri /admin?stats
7782 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7783 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7784 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7785
7786 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7787 backend private_monitoring
7788 stats enable
7789 stats uri /admin?stats
7790 stats refresh 5s
7791
7792 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7793
7794
7795stats enable
7796 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7797 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007798 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007799 Arguments : none
7800
7801 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7802 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7803 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7804 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7805 - stats auth : no authentication
7806 - stats scope : no restriction
7807
7808 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7809 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7810 unobvious parameters.
7811
7812 Example :
7813 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7814 backend public_www
7815 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7816 stats enable
7817 stats hide-version
7818 stats scope .
7819 stats uri /admin?stats
7820 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7821 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7822 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7823
7824 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7825 backend private_monitoring
7826 stats enable
7827 stats uri /admin?stats
7828 stats refresh 5s
7829
7830 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7831
7832
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007833stats hide-version
7834 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007836 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007837 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007838
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007839 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7840 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7841 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7842 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7843 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7844 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007845
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007846 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7847 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7848 unobvious parameters.
7849
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007850 Example :
7851 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7852 backend public_www
7853 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007854 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007855 stats hide-version
7856 stats scope .
7857 stats uri /admin?stats
7858 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7859 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7860 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007861
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007862 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7863 backend private_monitoring
7864 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007865 stats uri /admin?stats
7866 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007867
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007868 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007869
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007870
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007871stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7872 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7873 Access control for statistics
7874
7875 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7876 no | no | yes | yes
7877
7878 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7879 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7880 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7881 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7882 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7883 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7884
7885 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7886 instance.
7887
7888 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7889 about ACL usage.
7890
7891
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007892stats realm <realm>
7893 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007895 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007896 Arguments :
7897 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7898 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7899 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7900
7901 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7902 using a backslash ('\').
7903
7904 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7905 only related to authentication.
7906
7907 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7908 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7909 unobvious parameters.
7910
7911 Example :
7912 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7913 backend public_www
7914 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7915 stats enable
7916 stats hide-version
7917 stats scope .
7918 stats uri /admin?stats
7919 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7920 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7921 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7922
7923 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7924 backend private_monitoring
7925 stats enable
7926 stats uri /admin?stats
7927 stats refresh 5s
7928
7929 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7930
7931
7932stats refresh <delay>
7933 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007935 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007936 Arguments :
7937 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7938 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7939 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7940 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7941 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7942 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7943
7944 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7945 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7946 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7947 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7948
7949 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7950 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7951 unobvious parameters.
7952
7953 Example :
7954 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7955 backend public_www
7956 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7957 stats enable
7958 stats hide-version
7959 stats scope .
7960 stats uri /admin?stats
7961 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7962 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7963 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7964
7965 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7966 backend private_monitoring
7967 stats enable
7968 stats uri /admin?stats
7969 stats refresh 5s
7970
7971 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7972
7973
7974stats scope { <name> | "." }
7975 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007977 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007978 Arguments :
7979 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7980 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7981 section in which the statement appears.
7982
7983 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7984 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7985 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7986 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7987 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7988 exists.
7989
7990 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7991 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7992 unobvious parameters.
7993
7994 Example :
7995 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7996 backend public_www
7997 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7998 stats enable
7999 stats hide-version
8000 stats scope .
8001 stats uri /admin?stats
8002 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8003 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8004 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8005
8006 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8007 backend private_monitoring
8008 stats enable
8009 stats uri /admin?stats
8010 stats refresh 5s
8011
8012 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8013
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008014
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008015stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008016 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008018 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008019
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008020 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008021 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8022
8023 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8024 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8025
8026 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8027 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008028 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008029
8030 Example :
8031 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8032 backend private_monitoring
8033 stats enable
8034 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8035 stats uri /admin?stats
8036 stats refresh 5s
8037
8038 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8039 global section.
8040
8041
8042stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008043 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8045 yes | yes | yes | yes
8046 Arguments : none
8047
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008048 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008049 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8050 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8051 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8052 - IP (socket, server)
8053 - cookie (backend, server)
8054
8055 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8056 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008057 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008058
8059 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8060
8061
8062stats show-node [ <name> ]
8063 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008065 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008066 Arguments:
8067 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8068 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8069
8070 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8071 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008072 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008073
8074 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8075 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8076 unobvious parameters.
8077
8078 Example:
8079 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8080 backend private_monitoring
8081 stats enable
8082 stats show-node Europe-1
8083 stats uri /admin?stats
8084 stats refresh 5s
8085
8086 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8087 section.
8088
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008089
8090stats uri <prefix>
8091 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008093 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008094 Arguments :
8095 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8096 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8097 query string.
8098
8099 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8100 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8101 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8102 possible to reach it in the application.
8103
8104 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008105 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008106 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8107 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8108 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8109 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8110
8111 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8112 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8113 an address or a port to statistics only.
8114
8115 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8116 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8117 unobvious parameters.
8118
8119 Example :
8120 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8121 backend public_www
8122 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8123 stats enable
8124 stats hide-version
8125 stats scope .
8126 stats uri /admin?stats
8127 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8128 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8129 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8130
8131 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8132 backend private_monitoring
8133 stats enable
8134 stats uri /admin?stats
8135 stats refresh 5s
8136
8137 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8138
8139
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008140stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8141 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008142 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008143 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008144
8145 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008146 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008147 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8148 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8149 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8150
8151 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8152 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8153 the "stick-table" statement.
8154
8155 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8156 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8157 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8158 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8159 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8160
8161 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8162 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8163 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8164 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8165 transformation rules.
8166
8167 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8168 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8169 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8170 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8171 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8172 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8173 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8174
8175 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8176 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8177 ACL based conditions.
8178
8179 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8180 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8181 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8182 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8183
8184 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8185 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8186 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8187 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8188
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008189 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8190 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8191 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8192
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008193 Example :
8194 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8195 # last 30 minutes
8196 backend pop
8197 mode tcp
8198 balance roundrobin
8199 stick store-request src
8200 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8201 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8202 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8203
8204 backend smtp
8205 mode tcp
8206 balance roundrobin
8207 stick match src table pop
8208 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8209 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8210
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008211 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008212 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008213
8214
8215stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8216 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8217 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 no | no | yes | yes
8219
8220 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8221 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8222 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8223 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8224
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008225 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8226 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8227 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8228
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008229 Examples :
8230 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008231 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008232
8233 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8234 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8235 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8236
8237
8238 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8239 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8240 backend http
8241 mode http
8242 balance roundrobin
8243 stick on src table https
8244 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8245 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8246 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8247
8248 backend https
8249 mode tcp
8250 balance roundrobin
8251 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8252 stick on src
8253 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8254 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8255
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008256 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008257
8258
8259stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8260 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8261 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8262 no | no | yes | yes
8263
8264 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008265 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008266 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8267 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8268 server is selected.
8269
8270 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8271 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8272 the "stick-table" statement.
8273
8274 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8275 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8276 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8277 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8278 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8279 address.
8280
8281 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8282 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8283 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8284 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8285 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8286 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8287 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8288 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8289 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8290 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8291
8292 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8293 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8294 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8295 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8296 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8297 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8298 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8299
8300 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8301 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8302 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8303 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8304
8305 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8306 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8307 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8308 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8309 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8310 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008311 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8312 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8313 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8314 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8315 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8316 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008317
8318 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8319 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8320 the request.
8321
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008322 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8323 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8324 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8325
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008326 Example :
8327 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8328 # last 30 minutes
8329 backend pop
8330 mode tcp
8331 balance roundrobin
8332 stick store-request src
8333 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8334 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8335 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8336
8337 backend smtp
8338 mode tcp
8339 balance roundrobin
8340 stick match src table pop
8341 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8342 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8343
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008344 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008345 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008346
8347
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008348stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008349 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8350 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008351 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008352 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008353 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008354
8355 Arguments :
8356 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8357 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8358 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8359 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8360
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008361 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8362 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8363 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8364 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8365
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008366 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8367 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8368 instance.
8369
8370 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8371 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8372 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8373 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8374 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8375 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008376 to 32 characters.
8377
8378 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8379 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8380 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008381 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008382 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8383 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008384
8385 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008386 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8387 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008388 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8389 increase.
8390
8391 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008392 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8393 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8394 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008395
8396 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8397 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8398 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8399 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8400 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8401 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8402 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8403 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8404 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8405 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8406 parameter (see below).
8407
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008408 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8409 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8410 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8411 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8412 soft restart.
8413
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008414 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8415 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008416
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008417 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8418 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8419 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8420 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8421 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008422 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008423 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8424 if not expiration delay is specified.
8425
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008426 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8427 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8428 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8429 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008430 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8431 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8432 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8433 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8434 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8435 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8436 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8437 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8438 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8439 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8440 types and their arguments.
8441
8442 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8443 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8444 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8445 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8446
8447 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8448 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8449 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8450 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8451
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008452 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8453 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8454 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8455 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8456 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8457 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8458
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008459 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8460 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8461 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8462 they were received.
8463
8464 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8465 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8466 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8467 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8468 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8469
8470 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8471 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8472 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8473 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8474 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8475
8476 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8477 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8478 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8479
8480 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8481 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8482 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8483 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8484 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8485
8486 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8487 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8488 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8489 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8490 the client side.
8491
8492 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8493 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8494 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8495 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8496 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8497 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8498 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8499
8500 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8501 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8502 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8503 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8504 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8505 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8506 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8507
8508 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8509 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8510 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8511 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8512 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8513 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8514
8515 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8516 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8517 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8518 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8519
8520 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8521 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8522 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8523 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8524 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8525 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8526 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8527 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8528 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8529 recommended for better fairness.
8530
8531 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8532 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8533 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8534 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8535
8536 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8537 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8538 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8539 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8540 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8541 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8542 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8543 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8544 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8545 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008546
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008547 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8548 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008549 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8550 reference it.
8551
8552 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8553 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008554 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8555 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8556 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008557
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008558 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8559 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8560 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8561 something that can be ignored.
8562
8563 Example:
8564 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8565 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8566 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8567 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8568
8569 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008570 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008571
8572
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008573stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008574 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8576 no | no | yes | yes
8577
8578 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008579 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008580 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8581 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8582 server is selected.
8583
8584 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8585 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8586 the "stick-table" statement.
8587
8588 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8589 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8590 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8591 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8592
8593 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8594 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8595 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8596 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8597 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8598 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008599 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008600 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8601 rules.
8602
8603 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8604 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8605 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8606 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8607 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8608 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8609 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8610
8611 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8612 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8613 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8614 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8615
8616 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8617 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8618 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8619 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8620 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8621 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008622 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8623 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8624 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8625 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8626 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8627 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8628 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8629 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8630 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008631
8632 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8633
8634 Example :
8635 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8636 backend https
8637 mode tcp
8638 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008639 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008640 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008641
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008642 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8643 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8644
8645 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8646 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8647 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8648
8649 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8650 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008651
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008652 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8653 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8654 # at offset 44.
8655
8656 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8657 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8658
8659 # Learn on response if server hello.
8660 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008661
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008662 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8663 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8664
8665 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8666 extraction.
8667
8668
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008669tcp-check connect [params*]
8670 Opens a new connection
8671 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 no | no | yes | yes
8673
8674 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8675 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8676 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8677
8678 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8679 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8680 of the sequence.
8681
8682 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8683 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8684 do.
8685
8686 Parameters :
8687 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8688 use the TCP connection.
8689
8690 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8691 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8692 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8693
8694 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8695
8696 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8697
8698 Examples:
8699 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8700 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8701 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8702 option tcp-check
8703 tcp-check connect
8704 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8705 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8706 tcp-check send \r\n
8707 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8708 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8709 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8710 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8711 tcp-check send \r\n
8712 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8713 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8714
8715 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8716 option tcp-check
8717 tcp-check connect port 110
8718 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8719 tcp-check connect port 143
8720 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8721 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8722
8723 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8724
8725
8726tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8727 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8728 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8729 no | no | yes | yes
8730
8731 Arguments :
8732 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8733 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8734 binary.
8735 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8736 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8737 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8738
8739 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8740 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8741 with the usual backslash ('\').
8742 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8743 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8744 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8745 used upper or lower case.
8746
8747
8748 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8749
8750 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8751 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8752 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8753 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8754 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8755 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8756 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8757 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8758
8759 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8760 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8761 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8762 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8763 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8764 expression.
8765
8766 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8767 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8768 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8769 this exact hexadecimal string.
8770 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8771
8772 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8773 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8774 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8775 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8776 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8777 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8778 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8779 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8780 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8781 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8782 the null character.
8783
8784 Examples :
8785 # perform a POP check
8786 option tcp-check
8787 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8788
8789 # perform an IMAP check
8790 option tcp-check
8791 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8792
8793 # look for the redis master server
8794 option tcp-check
8795 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008796 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008797 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8798 tcp-check expect string role:master
8799 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8800 tcp-check expect string +OK
8801
8802
8803 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8804 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8805
8806
8807tcp-check send <data>
8808 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8809 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8810 no | no | yes | yes
8811
8812 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8813 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8814
8815 Examples :
8816 # look for the redis master server
8817 option tcp-check
8818 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8819 tcp-check expect string role:master
8820
8821 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8822 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8823
8824
8825tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8826 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8827 tcp health check
8828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8829 no | no | yes | yes
8830
8831 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8832 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8833 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8834 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8835 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8836 hexadecimal string.
8837 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8838
8839 Examples :
8840 # redis check in binary
8841 option tcp-check
8842 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8843 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8844
8845
8846 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8847 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8848
8849
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008850tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8851 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8853 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008854 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008855 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8856 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008857
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008858 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008859
8860 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8861 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008862 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8863 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8864 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8865 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8866 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8867 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008868
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008869 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8870 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8871 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8872 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008873
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008874 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008875 - accept :
8876 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8877 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8878 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008879
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008880 - reject :
8881 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8882 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8883 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8884 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8885 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8886 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8887 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8888 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8889 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8890 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8891 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008892 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008893
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008894 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8895 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8896 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8897 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8898 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8899 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8900 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8901 hosts.
8902
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008903 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8904 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8905 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8906 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8907 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8908 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8909 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8910 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8911
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008912 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8913 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8914 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8915 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8916 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8917 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8918 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8919 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8920 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008921 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8922 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008923
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008924 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008925 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008926 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008927 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008928 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8929 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008930 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008931 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8932 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8933 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8934 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8935 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008937 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008938 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008939 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008940 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8941 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8942 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8943 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008944
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008945 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8946 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8947 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8948 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008949
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008950 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8951 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8952 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8953 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8954 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008955 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8956 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8957 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8958 layer7 information is extracted.
8959
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008960 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8961 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8962 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8963 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8964 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008965
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008966 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8967 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8968 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8969 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8970
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008971 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8972 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8973 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8974 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8975 continues.
8976
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008977 - set-src <expr> :
8978 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8979 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8980 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8981 set-src"
8982
8983 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8984 followed by some converters.
8985
8986 Example:
8987
8988 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8989
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008990 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8991 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008992
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008993 - set-src-port <expr> :
8994 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8995 expression.
8996
8997 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8998 followed by some converters.
8999
9000 Example:
9001
9002 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9003
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009004 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9005 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9006 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009007
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009008 - set-dst <expr> :
9009 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9010 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9011 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9012 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9013 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9014
9015 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9016 followed by some converters.
9017
9018 Example:
9019
9020 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9021 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9022
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009023 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9024 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9025
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009026 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9027 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9028 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9029 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9030
9031
9032 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9033 followed by some converters.
9034
9035 Example:
9036
9037 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9038
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009039 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9040 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9041 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9042
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009043 - "silent-drop" :
9044 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9045 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9046 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9047 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9048 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9049 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9050 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9051 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9052 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9053 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9054 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9055 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9056 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9057 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9058 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9059 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9060
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009061 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9062 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9063 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009064
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009065 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9066 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9067 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009068
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009069 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009070 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009071 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009073 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9074 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9075 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009076
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009077 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009078 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9079 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009080
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009081 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9082
9083 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9084
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009085 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9086
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009087 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009088
9089
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009090tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9091 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009093 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009094 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009095 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9096 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009097
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009098 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009100 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9101 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9102 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9103 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9104 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009105
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009106 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9107 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9108 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9109 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009110 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9111 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9112 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9113 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9114 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9115 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009116 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009117 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009118
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009119 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9120 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9121 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9122 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009123
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009124 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009125 - accept : the request is accepted
9126 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9127 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009128 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009129 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009130 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009131 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009132 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009133 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009134
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009135 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9136 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009137
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009138 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9139 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9140 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9141 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9142 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9143 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009144
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009145 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009146 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9147 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009148
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009149 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009150 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9151 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9152 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9153 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009154 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9155 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9156 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009157
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009158 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009159 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9160 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9161 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009162
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009163 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009164 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9165 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009166
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009167 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9168 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009169 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009170 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9171 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009172 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009173 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009174 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009175 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9176 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009177 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009178 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9179 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009180
9181 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9182 followed by some converters.
9183
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009184 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9185 <var-name>.
9186
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009187 Example:
9188
9189 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009190 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009191
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009192 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009193 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9194 # and reject everything else.
9195 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9196 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009197 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009198 tcp-request content reject
9199
9200 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009201 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9202 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9203 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009204 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009205
9206 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9207 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9208 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009209 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009210 tcp-request content reject
9211
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009212 Example:
9213 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9214 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009215 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009216
9217 Example:
9218 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9219 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009220 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009222 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9223 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9224
9225 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009226 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009227 # protecting all our sites
9228 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009229 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9230 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009231 ...
9232 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9233
9234 backend http_dynamic
9235 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009236 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009237 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009238 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9239 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9240 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009241 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009242
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009243 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009244
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009245 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9246 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009247
9248
9249tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9250 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9251 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009252 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009253 Arguments :
9254 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9255 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9256 as explained at the top of this document.
9257
9258 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9259 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9260 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9261 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9262 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9263
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009264 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9265 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9266 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9267 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9268
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009269 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9270 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009271 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009272 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009273 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9274 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9275 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9276 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009277
9278 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9279 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9280 it pass through unaffected.
9281
9282 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9283 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9284 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009285 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009286 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9287 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009288 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9289 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9290 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009291
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009292 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009293 "timeout client".
9294
9295
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009296tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9297 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9298 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9299 no | no | yes | yes
9300 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009301 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9302 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009303
9304 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9305
9306 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9307 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9308 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009309 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9310 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009311
9312 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9313
9314 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9315 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9316 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9317 inserted.
9318
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009319 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009320 - accept :
9321 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9322 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9323 the rules evaluation.
9324
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009325 - close :
9326 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9327 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9328 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9329 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9330 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9331 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009332 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009333 protocols.
9334
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009335 - reject :
9336 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9337 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009338 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009339
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009340 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9341 Sets a variable.
9342
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009343 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9344 Unsets a variable.
9345
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009346 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9347 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9348 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9349 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9350
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009351 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9352 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9353 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9354 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9355 continues.
9356
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009357 - "silent-drop" :
9358 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9359 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9360 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9361 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9362 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9363 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9364 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9365 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9366 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9367 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9368 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9369 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9370 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9371 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9372 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9373 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9374
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009375 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9376 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9377 for changing the default action to a reject.
9378
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009379 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9380 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9381 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9382 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009383 period.
9384
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009385 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9386 declared inline.
9387
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009388 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9389 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009390 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009391 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9392 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009393 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009394 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009395 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009396 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9397 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009398 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009399 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9400 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009401
9402 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9403 followed by some converters.
9404
9405 Example:
9406
9407 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9408
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009409 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9410 <var-name>.
9411
9412 Example:
9413
9414 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9415
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009416 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9417
9418 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9419
9420
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009421tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9422 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9423 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9424 no | yes | yes | no
9425 Arguments :
9426 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9427 below.
9428
9429 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9430
9431 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9432 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9433 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9434 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9435 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9436 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9437 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9438 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9439 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9440 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9441 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9442 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9443 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9444 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9445 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9446 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9447 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9448 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9449 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9450 instead.
9451
9452 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9453 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9454 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9455 rules which may be inserted.
9456
9457 Several types of actions are supported :
9458 - accept : the request is accepted
9459 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9460 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9461 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9462 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9463 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009464 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009465 - silent-drop
9466
9467 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9468 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9469 sections for a complete description.
9470
9471 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9472 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9473 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9474
9475 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9476 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9477 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9478 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9479 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9480
9481 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9482 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9483
9484 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9485 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9486 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9487
9488 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9489 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9490 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9491
9492 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9493 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9494 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9495
9496 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9497 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9498 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9499
9500 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9501
9502 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9503
9504
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009505tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9506 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9508 no | no | yes | yes
9509 Arguments :
9510 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9511 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9512 as explained at the top of this document.
9513
9514 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9515
9516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009517timeout check <timeout>
9518 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9519 established.
9520
9521 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9522 yes | no | yes | yes
9523 Arguments:
9524 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9525 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9526 as explained at the top of this document.
9527
9528 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9529 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9530 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9531 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009532 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9533 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9534 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009535
9536 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9537 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9538
9539 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9540 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009541 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009542
9543 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9544 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9545 forget about it.
9546
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009547 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9548 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009549
9550
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009551timeout client <timeout>
9552timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9553 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9555 yes | yes | yes | no
9556 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009557 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009558 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9559 as explained at the top of this document.
9560
9561 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9562 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9563 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009564 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9565 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9566 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9567 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009568 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9569 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9570 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009571 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009572 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009573 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9574 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009575 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9576 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009577
9578 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9579 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9580 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9581 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9582 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9583 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9584
9585 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9586 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9587 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9588
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009589 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9590 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009591
9592
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009593timeout client-fin <timeout>
9594 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9595 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9596 yes | yes | yes | no
9597 Arguments :
9598 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9599 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9600 as explained at the top of this document.
9601
9602 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9603 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9604 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9605 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9606 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9607 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9608 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9609 down in one direction.
9610
9611 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9612 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9613 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9614
9615 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9616
9617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009618timeout connect <timeout>
9619timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9620 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9622 yes | no | yes | yes
9623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009624 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009625 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9626 as explained at the top of this document.
9627
9628 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009629 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009630 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009631 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009632 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9633 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009634
9635 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9636 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9637 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9638 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9639 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9640 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9641
9642 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9643 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9644 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9645
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009646 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9647 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009648
9649
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009650timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9651 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9653 yes | yes | yes | yes
9654 Arguments :
9655 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9656 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9657 as explained at the top of this document.
9658
9659 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9660 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9661 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9662 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9663 once the request has started to present itself.
9664
9665 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9666 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9667 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9668 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9669 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9670
9671 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9672 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9673 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9674 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9675
9676 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9677 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9678 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9679 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9680 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009681 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009682
9683 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9684 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9685 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9686 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9687
9688 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9689
9690
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009691timeout http-request <timeout>
9692 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009694 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009695 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009696 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009697 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9698 as explained at the top of this document.
9699
9700 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9701 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9702 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9703 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9704 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9705 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9706 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009707 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9708 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9709 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9710 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9711 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009712 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9713 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009714
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009715 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9716 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9717 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9718 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9719 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009720 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009721
9722 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9723 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9724 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9725 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9726 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9727
9728 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009729 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9730 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9731 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009732
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009733 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009734 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009735
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009736
9737timeout queue <timeout>
9738 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9740 yes | no | yes | yes
9741 Arguments :
9742 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9743 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9744 as explained at the top of this document.
9745
9746 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9747 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9748 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9749 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9750 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9751
9752 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9753 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9754 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9755 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9756
9757 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9758
9759
9760timeout server <timeout>
9761timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9762 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9764 yes | no | yes | yes
9765 Arguments :
9766 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9767 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9768 as explained at the top of this document.
9769
9770 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9771 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9772 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9773 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9774 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9775 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9776 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9777
9778 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9779 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9780 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9781 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9782 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009783 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009784 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009785 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9786 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9787 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9788 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009789
9790 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9791 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9792 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9793 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9794 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9795 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9796
9797 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9798 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9799 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9800
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009801 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009802
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009803
9804timeout server-fin <timeout>
9805 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9807 yes | no | yes | yes
9808 Arguments :
9809 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9810 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9811 as explained at the top of this document.
9812
9813 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9814 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9815 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9816 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9817 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9818 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9819 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9820 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9821 situations, it should not be needed.
9822
9823 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9824 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9825 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9826
9827 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9828
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009829
9830timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009831 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9833 yes | yes | yes | yes
9834 Arguments :
9835 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9836 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9837 as explained at the top of this document.
9838
9839 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9840 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9841 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9842
9843 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9844 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9845 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9846 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009847 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009848
9849 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9850
9851
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009852timeout tunnel <timeout>
9853 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9855 yes | no | yes | yes
9856 Arguments :
9857 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9858 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9859 as explained at the top of this document.
9860
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009861 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009862 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9863 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9864 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9865 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9866 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9867 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9868 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9869 specified.
9870
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009871 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9872 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9873 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9874 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9875 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9876 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9877 state.
9878
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009879 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9880 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9881 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9882 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9883 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9884
9885 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9886 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9887 forget about it.
9888
9889 Example :
9890 defaults http
9891 option http-server-close
9892 timeout connect 5s
9893 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009894 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009895 timeout server 30s
9896 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9897
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009898 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009899
9900
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009901transparent (deprecated)
9902 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9903 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009904 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009905 Arguments : none
9906
9907 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9908 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9909 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9910 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9911 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9912 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9913 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9914 appropriate server.
9915
9916 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9917
9918 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9919 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9920
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009921 See also: "option transparent"
9922
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009923unique-id-format <string>
9924 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9926 yes | yes | yes | no
9927 Arguments :
9928 <string> is a log-format string.
9929
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009930 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9931 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9932 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9933 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009934
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009935 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9936 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9937 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9938 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9939 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9940 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9941 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9942 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009943
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009944 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9945 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009946
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009947 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009948
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009949 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009950
9951 will generate:
9952
9953 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9954
9955 See also: "unique-id-header"
9956
9957unique-id-header <name>
9958 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9959 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9960 yes | yes | yes | no
9961 Arguments :
9962 <name> is the name of the header.
9963
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009964 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9965 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009966
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009967 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009968
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009969 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009970 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9971
9972 will generate:
9973
9974 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9975
9976 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009977
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009978use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009979 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009980 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9981 no | yes | yes | no
9982 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009983 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9984 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009985
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009986 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9987 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009988
9989 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9990 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9991 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009992 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9993 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9994 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9995 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009996
9997 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9998 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9999 assign the backend.
10000
10001 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10002 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10003 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10004 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10005 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10006 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10007
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010008 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010009 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010010 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10011 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10012 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10013
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010014 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10015 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10016 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10017 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10018 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10019 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10020 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10021 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10022 cannot be forced from the request.
10023
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010024 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010025 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10026 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10027
10028 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10029 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010030
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010031
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010032use-server <server> if <condition>
10033use-server <server> unless <condition>
10034 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10036 no | no | yes | yes
10037 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010038 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010039
10040 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10041
10042 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10043 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10044 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10045
10046 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10047 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10048 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10049 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10050 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10051 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10052 matches will assign the server.
10053
10054 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10055 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10056 with the next rules until one matches.
10057
10058 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10059 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10060 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10061 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10062
10063 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10064 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10065 stripped.
10066
10067 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10068 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10069 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10070 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10071
10072 Example :
10073 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10074 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10075 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10076 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10077 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10078 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010079 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010080 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10081 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10082
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010083 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010084
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010085
100865. Bind and Server options
10087--------------------------
10088
10089The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10090depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10091settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10092written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10093described in this section.
10094
10095
100965.1. Bind options
10097-----------------
10098
10099The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10100as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10101no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10102parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10103while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10104provided immediately after the setting name.
10105
10106The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10107
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010108accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10109 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10110 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10111 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10112 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10113 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10114 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10115 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10116 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10117 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010118 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10119 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10120 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010121
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010122accept-proxy
10123 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010124 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10125 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010126 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10127 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10128 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10129 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10130 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10131 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10132 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010133 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10134 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010135
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010136alpn <protocols>
10137 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10138 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10139 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10140 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10141 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10142 initial NPN extension.
10143
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010144backlog <backlog>
10145 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10146 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10147
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010148curves <curves>
10149 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10150 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10151 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10152 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10153 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10154 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10155
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010156ecdhe <named curve>
10157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010158 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10159 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010160
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010161ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010162 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10163 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10164 client's certificate.
10165
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010166ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10167 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10168 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10169 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10170 error is ignored.
10171
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010172ca-sign-file <cafile>
10173 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10174 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10175 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10176 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10177 'generate-certificates' for details.
10178
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010179ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10181 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10182 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10183 'generate-certificates' for details.
10184
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010185ciphers <ciphers>
10186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10187 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010188 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010189 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10190 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10191
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010192crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010193 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10194 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10195 to verify client's certificate.
10196
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010197crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010198 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10199 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10200 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10201 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10202 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10203 file.
10204
10205 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10206 are loaded.
10207
10208 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010209 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010210 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10211 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10212 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10213 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10214 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10215 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10216 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010217
10218 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10219 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10220 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10221 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010222 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10223 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010224
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010225 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010226
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010227 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10228 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010229 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010230 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10231 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10232 clients).
10233
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010234 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10235 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10236 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10237 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10238 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10239 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10240 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10241 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10242 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10243 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10244 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10245 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10246 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10247
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010248 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10249 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10250 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10251 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10252 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10253
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010254 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10255 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10256 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10257 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010258
10259 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10260 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10261 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10262 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10263 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10264 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10265 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10266 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10267 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10268
10269 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10270
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010271 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010272 a cert bundle.
10273
10274 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10275 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10276 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10277 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10278 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10279 provide multi-cert support.
10280
10281 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10282
10283 Filename | CN | SAN
10284 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10285 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010286 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010287 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10288 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10289
10290 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10291 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10292 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10293 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010294 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10295 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010296
10297 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10298 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10299
10300 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10301 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10302 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10303
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010304crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10306 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010307 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010308 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010309
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010310crt-list <file>
10311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010312 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10313 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010314
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010315 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10316
10317 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010318 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010319 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010320
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010321 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10322 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10323 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10324 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10325 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10326 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10327 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10328 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010329
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010330 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010331 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010332 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10333 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10334 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010335
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010336 crt-list file example:
10337 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010338 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010339 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010340 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010341
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010342defer-accept
10343 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10344 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10345 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10346 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10347 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10348 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10349 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10350 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10351 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10352 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10353 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10354
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010355force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010356 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010357 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010358 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10359 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010360
10361force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010362 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010363 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10364 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010365
10366force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010367 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010368 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10369 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010370
10371force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010372 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010373 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10374 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010375
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010376generate-certificates
10377 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10378 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10379 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10380 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10381 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10382 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10383 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10384 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10385 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10386 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10387 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10388
10389 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10390 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10391 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10392 certificate is used many times.
10393
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010394gid <gid>
10395 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10396 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10397 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10398 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10399 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10400
10401group <group>
10402 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10403 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10404 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10405 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10406 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10407
10408id <id>
10409 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10410 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10411 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10412 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10413
10414interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010415 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10416 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10417 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10418 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10419 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10420 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10421 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010422
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010423level <level>
10424 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10425 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10426 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10427 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10428 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10429 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10430 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10431 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10432 counters).
10433 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10434 all counters).
10435
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010436maxconn <maxconn>
10437 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10438 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10439 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10440 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10441 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10442 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10443 eat all memory.
10444
10445mode <mode>
10446 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10447 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10448 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10449 UNIX sockets.
10450
10451mss <maxseg>
10452 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10453 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10454 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10455 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10456 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10457 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10458 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10459 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10460 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10461 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10462 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10463
10464name <name>
10465 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10466 page.
10467
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010468namespace <name>
10469 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10470 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10471 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10472 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10473
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010474nice <nice>
10475 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10476 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10477 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10478 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10479 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10480 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10481 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10482 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10483 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10484 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10485 one for an RDP socket.
10486
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010487no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010489 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010490 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010491 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10492 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010493 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010494
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010495no-tls-tickets
10496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10497 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10498 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010499 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10500 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010501
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010502no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010504 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010505 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010506 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10507 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10508 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010509
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010510no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010511 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010512 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010513 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010514 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10515 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10516 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010517
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010518no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010519 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010520 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010521 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010522 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10523 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10524 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010525
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010526npn <protocols>
10527 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10528 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10529 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10530 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010531 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10532 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010533
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010534process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10535 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10536 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10537 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10538 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10539 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10540 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10541 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010542 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10543 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10544 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10545 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10546 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10547 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10548 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010549
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010550ssl
10551 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010552 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010553 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10554 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10555 to deciphered contents.
10556
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010557strict-sni
10558 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10559 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10560 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10561 See the "crt" option for more information.
10562
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010563tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010564 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010565 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10566 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010567 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010568 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10569 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10570 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10571 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10572 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10573 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10574 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10575
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010576tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010577 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010578 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10579 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10580 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10581 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10582 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10583 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10584 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010585 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10586 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10587 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010588
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010589tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10590 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10591 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10592 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10593 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10594 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10595 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10596 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10597 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10598 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10599 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10600
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010601transparent
10602 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10603 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10604 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10605 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10606 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10607 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10608 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10609 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10610 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10611 so check for support with your vendor.
10612
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010613v4v6
10614 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10615 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10616 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10617 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010618 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010619
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010620v6only
10621 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10622 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10623 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010624 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10625 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010626
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010627uid <uid>
10628 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10629 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10630 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10631 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10632 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10633
10634user <user>
10635 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10636 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10637 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10638 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10639 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10640
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010641verify [none|optional|required]
10642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10643 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10644 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10645 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10646 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010647 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10648 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10649 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10650 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010651
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200106525.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010653------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010655The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10656which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10657arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10658settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10659after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10660Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10661address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010663 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010664 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010665
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010666Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10667keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10668
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010669The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010670
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010671addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010672 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010673 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10674 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10675 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10676 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10677 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010678
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010679agent-check
10680 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010681 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10682 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10683 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10684 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010685
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010686 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010687 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010688 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10689 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10690 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010691
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010692 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10693 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10694 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10695 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10696 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10697
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010698 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10699 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010700
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010701 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10702 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10703 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010704
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010705 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10706 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10707 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010708
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010709 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10710 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10711 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10712 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10713 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10714 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10715 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010716
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010717 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10718 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010719
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010720 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10721 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10722 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10723 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10724 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10725 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10726 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10727 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10728 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010729
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010730 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10731 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010732 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10733 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10734 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010735 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010736
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010737 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010738 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010739
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010740agent-send <string>
10741 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10742 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10743 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10744 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10745 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10746
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010747agent-inter <delay>
10748 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10749 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10750
10751 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10752 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10753 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10754 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10755 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10756 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10757 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10758 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10759 of backends use the same servers.
10760
10761 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10762
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010763agent-addr <addr>
10764 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10765
10766 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10767 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10768 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10769 hostname, it will be resolved.
10770
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010771agent-port <port>
10772 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10773
10774 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10775
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010776backup
10777 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10778 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10779 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10780 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010781 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10782 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010783
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010784ca-file <cafile>
10785 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10786 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10787 server's certificate.
10788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010789check
10790 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010791 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10792 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10793 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10794 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10795 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10796 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10797 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010798 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10799 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010800 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10801 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010802
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010803check-send-proxy
10804 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10805 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10806 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10807 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10808 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10809 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10810 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10811
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010812check-ssl
10813 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10814 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10815 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10816 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010817 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010818 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10819 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10820 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010821 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10822 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010823
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010824ciphers <ciphers>
10825 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010826 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010827 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10828 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10829 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10830 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10831 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10832 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10833
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010834cookie <value>
10835 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10836 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10837 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10838 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10839 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10840 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10841 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10842
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010843crl-file <crlfile>
10844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10845 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10846 to verify server's certificate.
10847
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010848crt <cert>
10849 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10850 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10851 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10852 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10853 certificate request.
10854
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010855disabled
10856 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10857 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10858 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10859 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10860 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010861 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010862
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010863enabled
10864 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
10865 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
10866 default value.
10867 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
10868 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010869
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010870error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010871 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10872 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10873 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010874
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010875 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010876
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010877fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010878 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10879 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10880 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10881
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010882force-sslv3
10883 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10884 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010885 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010886 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-sslv3", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010887
10888force-tlsv10
10889 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010890 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010891 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv10", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010892
10893force-tlsv11
10894 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010895 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010896 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv11", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010897
10898force-tlsv12
10899 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010900 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010901 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-force-tlsv12", "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010902
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010903id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010904 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10905 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10906 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010907
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010908init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10909 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10910 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10911 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10912 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10913 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10914 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10915 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10916 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10917 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10918 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10919 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10920 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10921 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10922 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10923 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10924 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10925 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10926 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10927 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10928 historic behaviour.
10929
10930 Example:
10931 defaults
10932 # never fail on address resolution
10933 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10934
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010935inter <delay>
10936fastinter <delay>
10937downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010938 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10939 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10940 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10941 between checks depending on the server state :
10942
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010943 Server state | Interval used
10944 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10945 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10946 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10947 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10948 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10949 or yet unchecked. |
10950 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10951 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10952 | "inter" otherwise.
10953 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010954
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010955 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10956 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10957 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10958 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010959 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10960 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10961 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10962 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10963 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010964
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010965maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010966 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10967 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10968 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10969 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10970 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10971 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10972 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10973 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10974
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010975maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010976 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10977 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10978 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10979 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10980 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10981 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10982 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010984minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010985 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10986 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10987 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10988 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10989 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10990 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010991 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010992 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010993
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010994namespace <name>
10995 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10996 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10997 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10998 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10999
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011000no-agent-check
11001 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11002 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11003 default value.
11004 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11005 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11006
11007no-backup
11008 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11009 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11010 default value.
11011 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11012 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11013
11014no-check
11015 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11016 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11017 default value.
11018 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11019 "default-server" "check" setting.
11020
11021no-check-ssl
11022 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11023 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11024 default value.
11025 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11026 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11027
11028no-force-sslv3
11029 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-sslv3"
11030 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11031 default value.
11032 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11033 "default-server" "force-sslv3" setting.
11034
11035no-force-tlsv10
11036 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv10"
11037 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11038 default value.
11039 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11040 "default-server" "force-tlsv10" setting.
11041
11042no-force-tlsv11
11043 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv11"
11044 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11045 default value.
11046 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11047 "default-server" "force-tlsv11" setting.
11048
11049no-force-tlsv12
11050 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "force-tlsv12"
11051 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11052 default value.
11053 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11054 "default-server" "force-tlsv12" setting.
11055
11056no-send-proxy
11057 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11058 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11059 default value.
11060 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11061 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11062
11063no-send-proxy-v2
11064 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11065 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11066 default value.
11067 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11068 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11069
11070no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11071 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11072 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11073 default value.
11074 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11075 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11076
11077no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11078 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11079 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11080 default value.
11081 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11082 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11083
11084no-ssl
11085 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11086 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11087 default value.
11088 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11089 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11090
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011091no-ssl-reuse
11092 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11093 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11094 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11095 and for paranoid users.
11096
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011097no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011098 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11099 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011100 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011101
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011102no-tls-tickets
11103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11104 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11105 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011106 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11107 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011108 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011109
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011110no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011111 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011112 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11113 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011114 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11115 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011116 See also "tlsv10", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011117
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011118no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011119 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011120 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11121 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011122 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11123 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011124 See also "tlsv11", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011125
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011126no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011127 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011128 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11129 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011130 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11131 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011132 See also "tlsv12", "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011133
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011134no-verifyhost
11135 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11136 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11137 default value.
11138 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11139 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011140
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011141non-stick
11142 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11143 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11144 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11145
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011146observe <mode>
11147 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11148 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11149 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11150 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11151 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11152 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011153 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011154
11155 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11156
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011157on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011158 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11159 Currently, four modes are available:
11160 - fastinter: force fastinter
11161 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11162 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11163 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11164 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11165
11166 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11167
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011168on-marked-down <action>
11169 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11170 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011171 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11172 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11173 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11174 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11175 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11176 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11177 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11178 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011179
11180 Actions are disabled by default
11181
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011182on-marked-up <action>
11183 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11184 Currently one action is available:
11185 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11186 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11187 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11188 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11189 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11190 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11191 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11192 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11193
11194 Actions are disabled by default
11195
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011196port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011197 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11198 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11199 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11200 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11201 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11202 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11203
11204redir <prefix>
11205 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11206 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11207 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11208 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11209 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11210 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11211 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11212 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011213 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011214 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11215 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11216 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11217 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11218 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11219
11220 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11221
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011222rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011223 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11224 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11225 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11226
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011227resolve-prefer <family>
11228 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11229 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11230 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11231 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11232
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011233 Default value: ipv6
11234
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011235 Example:
11236
11237 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011238
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011239resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11240 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11241 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011242 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011243 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11244 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11245 configured network, another address is selected.
11246
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011247 Example:
11248
11249 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011250
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011251resolvers <id>
11252 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11253 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011254 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11255 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11256 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11257 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011258
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011259 Example:
11260
11261 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011262
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011263 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011264
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011265send-proxy
11266 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11267 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11268 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11269 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011270 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11271 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11272 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11273 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11274 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11275 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11276 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11277 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11278 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11279 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011280 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11281 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011282
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011283send-proxy-v2
11284 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11285 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11286 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11287 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11288 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011289 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11290 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11291 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011292
11293send-proxy-v2-ssl
11294 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11295 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11296 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11297 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11298 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11299 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11300 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011301 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11302 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011303
11304send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11305 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11306 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11307 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11308 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11309 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11310 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11311 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11312 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011313 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11314 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011316slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011317 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11318 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11319 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11320 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11321 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11322 parameters :
11323
11324 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11325 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11326
11327 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11328 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11329 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11330 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11331
11332 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11333 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11334 seen as failed.
11335
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011336sni <expression>
11337 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11338 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11339 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11340 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11341 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11342
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011343source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011344source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011345source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011346 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11347 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11348 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11349 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11350
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011351 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11352 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11353 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11354 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11355 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11356 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11357 server.
11358
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011359 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11360 specifying the source address without port(s).
11361
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011362ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011363 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11364 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11365 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11366 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11367 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11368 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011369 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11370 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011371
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011372sslv3
11373 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-sslv3"
11374 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11375 default value.
11376 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11377 "default-server" "no-sslv3" setting.
11378
11379ssl-reuse
11380 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11381 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11382 default value.
11383 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11384 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11385
11386stick
11387 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11388 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11389 default value.
11390 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11391 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011392
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011393tcp-ut <delay>
11394 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11395 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11396 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011397 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011398 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11399 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11400 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11401 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11402 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11403 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11404 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11405 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11406 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11407
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011408track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011409 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11410 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11411 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11412 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011413 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11414
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011415tlsv10
11416 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv10"
11417 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11418 default value.
11419 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11420 "default-server" "no-tlsv10" setting.
11421
11422tlsv11
11423 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv11"
11424 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11425 default value.
11426 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11427 "default-server" "no-tlsv11" setting.
11428
11429tlsv12
11430 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tlsv12"
11431 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11432 default value.
11433 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11434 "default-server" "no-tlsv12" setting.
11435
11436tls-tickets
11437 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11438 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11439 default value.
11440 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11441 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011442
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011443verify [none|required]
11444 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011445 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11446 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11447 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11448 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011449 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11450 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11451 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011452
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011453verifyhost <hostname>
11454 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11455 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11456 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11457 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11458 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11459 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011460 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011461
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011462weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011463 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11464 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11465 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011466 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11467 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11468 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11469 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11470 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11471 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011472
11473
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114745.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11475-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011476
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011477HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11478using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11479configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011480This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11481can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11482workload.
11483This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11484resolution at run time.
11485Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11486carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11487
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011488Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11489health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11490
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011491
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114925.3.1. Global overview
11493----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011494
11495As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11496different steps of the process life:
11497
11498 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11499 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11500 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11501
11502 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11503 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11504 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11505
11506A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11507 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11508 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11509 resolution to know this new IP.
11510
11511A few things important to notice:
11512 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11513 first valid response.
11514
11515 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11516 servers return an error.
11517
11518
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115195.3.2. The resolvers section
11520----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011521
11522This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11523HAProxy.
11524There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11525many name servers.
11526
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011527When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11528uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11529is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11530answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11531
11532When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11533used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11534
11535Two types of behavior can be applied:
11536 1. stop DNS resolution
11537 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11538 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11539 1. ANY query type
11540 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11541 server's parameter
11542 3. remaining family type
11543
11544HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11545 - invalid DNS response packet
11546 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11547 - NX domain
11548 - Query refused by server
11549 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11550
11551HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11552 - no Answer records in the response
11553 - DNS response truncated
11554 - Error in DNS response
11555 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11556 - name server timeout
11557
11558For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11559 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11560 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11561 applied;
11562 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11563 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11564 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11565 stops resolution.
11566
11567
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011568resolvers <resolvers id>
11569 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11570
11571A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11572
11573nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11574 DNS server description:
11575 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11576 <ip> : IP address of the server
11577 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11578
11579hold <status> <period>
11580 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11581 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011582 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11583 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011584 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11585 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11586 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11587
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011588 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011589
11590 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11591 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11592 the healch check.
11593
11594resolve_retries <nb>
11595 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11596 giving up.
11597 Default value: 3
11598
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011599 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11600 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11601 type.
11602
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011603timeout <event> <time>
11604 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11605 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11606 events available are:
11607 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11608 been received.
11609 Default value: 1s
11610 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11611 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11612
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011613 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011614
11615 resolvers mydns
11616 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11617 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11618 resolve_retries 3
11619 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011620 hold other 30s
11621 hold refused 30s
11622 hold nx 30s
11623 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011624 hold valid 10s
11625
11626
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200116276. HTTP header manipulation
11628---------------------------
11629
11630In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11631response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11632request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11633which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011634against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011635
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011636If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11637to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11638but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11639HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11640stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11641because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11642a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11643still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011644
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011645This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11646in section 4.2 :
11647
11648 - reqadd <string>
11649 - reqallow <search>
11650 - reqiallow <search>
11651 - reqdel <search>
11652 - reqidel <search>
11653 - reqdeny <search>
11654 - reqideny <search>
11655 - reqpass <search>
11656 - reqipass <search>
11657 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11658 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11659 - reqtarpit <search>
11660 - reqitarpit <search>
11661 - rspadd <string>
11662 - rspdel <search>
11663 - rspidel <search>
11664 - rspdeny <search>
11665 - rspideny <search>
11666 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11667 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11668
11669With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11670is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11671parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11672prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11673Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11674
11675 \t for a tab
11676 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11677 \n for a new line (LF)
11678 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11679 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11680 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11681 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11682 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11683
11684The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11685portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11686above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11687regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
116889 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11689is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11690
11691The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11692after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11693
11694Notes related to these keywords :
11695---------------------------------
11696 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11697 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11698 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11699
11700 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11701 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11702 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11703
11704 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11705 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11706 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11707 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11708 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11709
11710 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11711 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11712 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11713 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11714 useless headers before adding new ones.
11715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011716 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011717 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11718
11719 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11720 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11721 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11722
11723 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11724 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011725 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011726
11727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200117287. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11729----------------------------------
11730
11731Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11732client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11733The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11734these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11735but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11736data called patterns.
11737
11738
117397.1. ACL basics
11740---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011741
11742The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11743content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11744from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11745simple :
11746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011747 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011748 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011749 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11750 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11753adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011754
11755In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011757 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011758
11759This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11760Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11761and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011762an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11763conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11764as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11765are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011766
11767ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11768'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11769which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11770
11771There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11772performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011774The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11775specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11776this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011777methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11778ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011779
11780Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11781 - boolean
11782 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11783 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11784 - string
11785 - data block
11786
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011787Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11788converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11789would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11790The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11791which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11792
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011793Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11794keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11795fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11796which are summarized in the table below :
11797
11798 +---------------------+-----------------+
11799 | Sample or converter | Default |
11800 | output type | matching method |
11801 +---------------------+-----------------+
11802 | boolean | bool |
11803 +---------------------+-----------------+
11804 | integer | int |
11805 +---------------------+-----------------+
11806 | ip | ip |
11807 +---------------------+-----------------+
11808 | string | str |
11809 +---------------------+-----------------+
11810 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11811 +---------------------+-----------------+
11812
11813Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11814matching method, see below.
11815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011816The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11817 - boolean
11818 - integer or integer range
11819 - IP address / network
11820 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11821 - regular expression
11822 - hex block
11823
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011824The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11825
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011826 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11827 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011828 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011829 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011830 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011831 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011832 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011834The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11835read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11836if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11837lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11838will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11839beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11840a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11841lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11842exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11843
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011844The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11845parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11846ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11847a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11848check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11849
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011850The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11851socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11852file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011854Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11855loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11856
11857 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11858
11859In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11860the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11861case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11862as well.
11863
11864The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11865sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11866do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11867methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11868is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11869obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11870followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11871default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11872that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11873string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11874
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011875The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11876By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11877string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11878resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11879server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11880waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11881flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11882function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011884There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11885sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11886be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011887
11888 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11889 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011890 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11891 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11892 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11893 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011894
11895 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11896 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011897 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011898
11899 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011900 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011901
11902 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011903 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011904
11905 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11906 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11907
11908 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11909 binary or string samples.
11910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011911 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11912 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011914 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11915 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11916 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011918 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11919 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011921 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11922 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011924 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11925 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011927 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11928 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011929 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011931 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11932 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11933 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011934
11935For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11936request, it is possible to do :
11937
11938 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11939
11940In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11941buffer, one would use the following acl :
11942
11943 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11944
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011945On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11946possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11947
11948 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11949
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011950All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11951criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11952method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11953to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11954criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11955the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011957If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011958the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11959For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11962 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11963 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11964 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011965
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011966
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011967The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11968types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11969combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11970brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11971default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011972
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011973 +-------------------------------------------------+
11974 | Input sample type |
11975 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011976 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011977 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11978 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11979 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011980 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011981 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011982 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011983 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011984 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011985 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011986 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011987 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011988 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011989 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011990 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011991 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011992 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011993 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011994 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011995 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011996 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011997 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011998 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012000 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012001 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12002 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12003 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012004
12005
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120067.1.1. Matching booleans
12007------------------------
12008
12009In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12010Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12011When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12012that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12013
12014Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12015return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12016"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120197.1.2. Matching integers
12020------------------------
12021
12022Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12023enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12024to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12025
12026Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12027matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12028lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012029
12030For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12031unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12032representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12033
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012034As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12035two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12036instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12037ranges and operators.
12038
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012039For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012040operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12041Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12042of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012043
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012044Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012045
12046 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12047 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12048 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12049 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12050 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12051
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012052For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012053
12054 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12055
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012056This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12057
12058 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12059
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012060
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120617.1.3. Matching strings
12062-----------------------
12063
12064String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12065different forms :
12066
12067 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12068 patterns ;
12069
12070 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12071 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12072
12073 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12074 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12075
12076 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12077 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12078
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012079 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012080 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12081 matches.
12082
12083 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12084 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12085 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012086
12087String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12088exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12089characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12090string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12091to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012092before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012093
12094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120957.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12096---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012097
12098Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12099they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12100possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12101passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12102the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012103the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12104match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012105
12106
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121077.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12108-------------------------------------
12109
12110It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12111not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12112a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12113to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12114digits may be used upper or lower case.
12115
12116Example :
12117 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12118 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12119
12120
121217.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12122---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012123
12124IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12125netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12126within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012127host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012128difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12129at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12130does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12131parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012132
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012133The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12134abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12135
12136 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12137 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12138 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12139 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12140 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12141 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12142 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12143 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12144
12145Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12146192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12147
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012148IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12149Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12150trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12151IPv6 patterns.
12152
12153HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12154following situations :
12155 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12156 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12157 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12158 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12159 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12160 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12161 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12162 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12163 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12164 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012166
121677.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12168----------------------------------
12169
12170Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12171combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12172
12173 - AND (implicit)
12174 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12175 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012176
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012177A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012179 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012181Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12182indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012183
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012184For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12185"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12186requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12187is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12188
12189 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12190 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12191 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12192 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
12193
12194To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12195and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12196
12197 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12198 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12199 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12200 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12201
12202 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12203 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12204 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12205 use_backend www if host_www
12206
12207It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12208expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12209be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12210the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12211
12212 The following rule :
12213
12214 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12215 block if METH_POST missing_cl
12216
12217 Can also be written that way :
12218
12219 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
12220
12221It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12222to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12223simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12224sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12225good use is the following :
12226
12227 With named ACLs :
12228
12229 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12230 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12231 monitor fail if site_dead
12232
12233 With anonymous ACLs :
12234
12235 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12236
12237See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12238
12239
122407.3. Fetching samples
12241---------------------
12242
12243Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12244against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12245sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12246ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12247of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12248available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12249
12250This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12251Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12252compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12253deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12254
12255The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12256matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12257method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12258indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12259
12260As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12261when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12262mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12263the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12264ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12265
12266Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12267multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12268when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12269incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12270are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12271is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12272all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12273
12274Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12275 - name
12276 - name(arg1)
12277 - name(arg1,arg2)
12278
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012279
122807.3.1. Converters
12281-----------------
12282
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012283Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12284of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12285is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12286was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12287has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12288unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12289
12290These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12291sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12292the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12293support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012294
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012295A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12296support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12297supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12298(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12299bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012301The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012302
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001230351d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12304 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12305 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12306 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12307 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12308 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12309
12310 Example :
12311 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12312 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12313 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12314 frontend http-in
12315 bind *:8081
12316 default_backend servers
12317 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12318 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12319
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012320add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012321 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012322 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012323 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12324 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012325 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012326 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12327 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12328 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12329 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12330 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012331 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012332
12333and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012334 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012335 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012336 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12337 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012338 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012339 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12340 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12341 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12342 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12343 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012344 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012345
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012346base64
12347 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12348 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12349 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12350
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012351bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012352 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012353 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12354 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12355 presence of a flag).
12356
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012357bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12358 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12359 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012360 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012361
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012362cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012363 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12364 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012365
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012366crc32([<avalanche>])
12367 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12368 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12369 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12370 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12371 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12372 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12373 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12374 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12375 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12376 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12377 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12378
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012379da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012380 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12381 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12382 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12383 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012384 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012385 configuration language.
12386
12387 Example:
12388 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012389 bind *:8881
12390 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012391 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012392
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012393debug
12394 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12395 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12396 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12397
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012398div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012399 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12400 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012401 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012402 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12403 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012404 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012405 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12406 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12407 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12408 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12409 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012410 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012411
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012412djb2([<avalanche>])
12413 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12414 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12415 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12416 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12417 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12418 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12419 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012420 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12421 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012422
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012423even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012424 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012425 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12426
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012427field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12428 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12429 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12430 list of chars.
12431
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012432hex
12433 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12434 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12435 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12436 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012437
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012438http_date([<offset>])
12439 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12440 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12441 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12442 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12443 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12444 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012445
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012446in_table(<table>)
12447 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12448 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12449 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12450 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12451 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12452
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012453ipmask(<mask>)
12454 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12455 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12456 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12457 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12458
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012459json([<input-code>])
12460 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12461 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012462 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012463 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12464 of errors:
12465 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12466 bytes, ...)
12467 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12468 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12469
12470 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12471 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12472 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12473 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12474 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12475 are :
12476 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12477 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12478 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12479 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12480 error ;
12481 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12482 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12483
12484 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12485 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12486
12487 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012488 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012489 capture request header user-agent len 150
12490 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012491
12492 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12493 GET / HTTP/1.0
12494 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12495
12496 Output log:
12497 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012499language(<value>[,<default>])
12500 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12501 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12502 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12503 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12504 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12505 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12506 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12507 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12508 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12509 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12510 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12511 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012512
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012513 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012514
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012515 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12516 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012517
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012518 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12519 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12520 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12521 use_backend spanish if es
12522 use_backend french if fr
12523 use_backend english if en
12524 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012525
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012526lower
12527 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12528 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12529 type. The result is of type string.
12530
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012531ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12532 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12533 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12534 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12535 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12536 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12537 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12538
12539 Example :
12540
12541 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12542 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12543 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12544
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012545map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12546map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12547map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12548 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12549 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12550 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12551 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12552 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12553 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12554 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12555 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012556
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012557 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12558 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12559 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012560
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012561 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012562 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012563
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012564 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12565 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12566 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12567 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012568 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12569 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012570 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12571 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12572 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12573 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12574 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12575 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12576 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12577 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012578 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12579 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12580 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012581 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12582 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12583 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12584 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12585 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012586
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012587 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12588 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12589 the corresponding match text.
12590
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012591 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12592 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12593 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12594 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12595 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012596
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012597 Example :
12598
12599 # this is a comment and is ignored
12600 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12601 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12602 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12603 | | | `---------- value
12604 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12605 | `---------------------------- key
12606 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12607
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012608mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012609 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12610 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012611 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012612 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012613 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012614 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12615 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12616 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12617 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12618 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012619 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012620
12621mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012622 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012623 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12624 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012625 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012626 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012627 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012628 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12629 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12630 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12631 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12632 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012633 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012634
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012635nbsrv
12636 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12637 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12638 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12639 map lookup.
12640
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012641neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012642 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12643 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12644 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12645 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012646
12647not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012648 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012649 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12650 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12651 absence of a flag).
12652
12653odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012654 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012655 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12656
12657or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012658 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012659 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012660 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12661 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012662 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012663 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12664 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12665 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12666 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12667 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012668 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012669
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012670regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012671 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12672 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12673 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12674 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12675 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12676 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12677 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12678 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12679 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12680 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012681 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12682 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12683 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12684 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012685
12686 Example :
12687
12688 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12689 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12690 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12691 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12692
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012693capture-req(<id>)
12694 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12695 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12696
12697 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012698 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12699 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012700
12701capture-res(<id>)
12702 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12703 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12704
12705 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012706 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12707 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012708
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012709sdbm([<avalanche>])
12710 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12711 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12712 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12713 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12714 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12715 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12716 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012717 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12718 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012719
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012720set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012721 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12722 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12723 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012724 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012725 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12726 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012727 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012728 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12729 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012730 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012731 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012732
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012733sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012734 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12735 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012736 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012737 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12738 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012739 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012740 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12741 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012742 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012743 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12744 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012745 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012746 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012747
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012748table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12749 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12750 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12751 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12752 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12753 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12754 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12755
12756
12757table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12758 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12759 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12760 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12761 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12762 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12763 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12764
12765table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12766 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12767 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12768 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12769 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12770 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12771
12772table_conn_cur(<table>)
12773 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12774 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12775 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12776 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12777 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12778
12779table_conn_rate(<table>)
12780 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12781 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12782 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12783 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12784 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12785
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012786table_gpt0(<table>)
12787 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12788 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12789 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12790 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12791 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12792
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012793table_gpc0(<table>)
12794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12796 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12797 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12798 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12799
12800table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12801 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12802 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12803 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12804 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12805 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12806 sample fetch keyword.
12807
12808table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12811 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12812 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12813 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12814
12815table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12816 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12817 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12818 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12819 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12820 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12821 keyword.
12822
12823table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12824 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12825 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12826 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12827 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12828 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12829
12830table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12831 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12832 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12833 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12834 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12835 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12836 keyword.
12837
12838table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12839 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12840 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12841 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12842 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12843 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12844 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12845 keyword.
12846
12847table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12848 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12849 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12850 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12851 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12852 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12853 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12854 keyword.
12855
12856table_server_id(<table>)
12857 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12858 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12859 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12860 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12861 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12862 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12863
12864table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12865 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12866 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12867 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12868 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12869 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12870 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12871 keyword.
12872
12873table_sess_rate(<table>)
12874 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12875 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12876 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12877 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12878 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12879 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12880 keyword.
12881
12882table_trackers(<table>)
12883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12886 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12887 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12888 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12889 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12890 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12891 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12892 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12893
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012894upper
12895 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12896 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12897 type. The result is of type string.
12898
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012899url_dec
12900 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12901 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12902
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012903unset-var(<var name>)
12904 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12905 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12906 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12907 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12908 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12909 response),
12910 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12911 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12912 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12913 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12914
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012915utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12916 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12917 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12918 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12919 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12920 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12921 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12922
12923 Example :
12924
12925 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12926 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12927 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12928
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012929word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12930 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12931 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12932
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012933wt6([<avalanche>])
12934 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12935 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12936 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12937 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12938 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12939 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12940 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012941 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12942 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012943
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012944xor(<value>)
12945 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012946 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012947 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012948 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012949 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012950 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12951 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012952 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012953 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12954 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012955 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012956 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012957
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012958xxh32([<seed>])
12959 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12960 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12961 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12962 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12963 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12964 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12965 as cryptographically secure.
12966
12967xxh64([<seed>])
12968 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12969 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12970 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12971 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12972 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12973 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12974 as cryptographically secure.
12975
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012976
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200129777.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012978--------------------------------------------
12979
12980A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12981not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12982"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12983The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12984
12985always_false : boolean
12986 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12987 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12988
12989always_true : boolean
12990 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12991 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12992
12993avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012994 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012995 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12996 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12997 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12998 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12999 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13000 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13001 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13002 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13003 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13004 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13005 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13006 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13007 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013009be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013010 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13011 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13012 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13013 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13014 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013016be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13017 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13018 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13019 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13020 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13021 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13022 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013023
13024 Example :
13025 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13026 backend dynamic
13027 mode http
13028 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13029 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013030
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013031bin(<hexa>) : bin
13032 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13033 of the string.
13034
13035bool(<bool>) : bool
13036 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13037 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013039connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13040 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013041 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013042 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13043 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013044
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013045 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013046 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013047 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13048
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013049 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13050 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013051
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013052 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013053 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013054 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013055 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13056 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013057 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013058 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013059
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013060 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13061 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013063 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013064
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013065date([<offset>]) : integer
13066 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13067 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13068 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13069 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013070 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13071
13072 Example :
13073
13074 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13075 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013076
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013077env(<name>) : string
13078 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13079 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13080 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13081 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13082 certain way.
13083
13084 Examples :
13085 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13086 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13087
13088 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13089 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013091fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13092 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013093 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13094 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13096 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13097 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13098 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13099 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013100
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013101fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13102 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13103 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13104 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013106fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13107 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13108 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13109 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13110 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13111 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13112 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13113 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13114 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013115
13116 Example :
13117 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13118 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13119 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13120 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13121 frontend mail
13122 bind :25
13123 mode tcp
13124 maxconn 100
13125 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13126 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13127 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13128 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013129
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013130hostname : string
13131 Returns the system hostname.
13132
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013133int(<integer>) : signed integer
13134 Returns a signed integer.
13135
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013136ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13137 Returns an ipv4.
13138
13139ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13140 Returns an ipv6.
13141
13142meth(<method>) : method
13143 Returns a method.
13144
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013145nbproc : integer
13146 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13147 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13148 and debugging purposes.
13149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013150nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13151 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13152 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13153 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013154 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13155 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13156 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013157
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013158proc : integer
13159 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13160 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13161 debugging purposes.
13162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013163queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013164 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13165 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13166 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013167 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13168 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13169 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13170 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13171 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13172
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013173rand([<range>]) : integer
13174 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13175 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13176 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13177 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13178 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013180srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13181 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13182 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13183 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13184 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13185 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13186 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13187 methods.
13188
13189srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13190 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13191 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13192 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13193 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13194 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13195 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13196 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13197
13198srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13199 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13200 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013201 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013202 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13203 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13204 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13205 overloading servers).
13206
13207 Example :
13208 # Redirect to a separate back
13209 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13210 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13211 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13212
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013213stopping : boolean
13214 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13215 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13216 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13217
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013218str(<string>) : string
13219 Returns a string.
13220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013221table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13222 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13223 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13224
13225table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13226 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13227 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13228 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13229
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013230var(<var-name>) : undefined
13231 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013232 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13233 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013234 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013235 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13236 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013237 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013238 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13239 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013240 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013241 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013242
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200132437.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013244----------------------------------
13245
13246The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13247closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13248methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13249sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13250TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013251the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13252counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13253"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013254argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13255the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13256this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257
13258be_id : integer
13259 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13260 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13261
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013262be_name : string
13263 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13264 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013266dst : ip
13267 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13268 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13269 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13270 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13271 RFC 4291.
13272
13273dst_conn : integer
13274 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13275 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13276 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13277 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13278 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13279 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13280 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13281 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013282
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013283dst_is_local : boolean
13284 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13285 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13286 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13287 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13288 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13289 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13290 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13291 it only once per connection.
13292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013293dst_port : integer
13294 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13295 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13296 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13297 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13298 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13299 an HTTP header.
13300
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013301fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13302 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13303 header.
13304
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013305fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13306 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13307 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13308 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13309 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13310 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13311 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13312
13313fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13314 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13315 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13316 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13317 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13318 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13319 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13320
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013321fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13322 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13323 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13324 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13325 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13326
13327fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13328 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13329 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13330 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13331 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13332
13333fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13334 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13335 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13336 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13337 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13338
13339fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13340 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13341 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13342 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13343 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13344
13345fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13346 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13347 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13348 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13349 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13350
13351fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13352 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13353 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13354 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13355 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013357fe_id : integer
13358 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013359 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013360 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13361
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013362fe_name : string
13363 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13364 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13365 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13366
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013367sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013368sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13369sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13370sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013371 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13372 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13373 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13374
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013375sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013376sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13377sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13378sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013379 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13380 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13381 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13382
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013383sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013384sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13385sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13386sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013387 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13388 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013389 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13390 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13391 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013392
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013393 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013394 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13395 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013396 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13397 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13398 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013399 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13400 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13401
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013402sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013403sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13404sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13405sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013406 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13407 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13408
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013409sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013410sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13411sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13412sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013413 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13414 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13415 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13416
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013417sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013418sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13419sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13420sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013421 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13422 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13423 See also src_conn_rate.
13424
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013425sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013426sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13427sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13428sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013429 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013430 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013431
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013432sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13433sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13434sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13435sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13436 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13437 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13438
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013439sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013440sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13441sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13442sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013443 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13444 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13445 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013446 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13447 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13448 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013449
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013450sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013451sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13452sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13453sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013454 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13455 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13456 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13457
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013458sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013459sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13460sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13461sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013462 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13463 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13464 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13465 src_http_err_rate.
13466
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013467sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013468sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13469sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13470sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013471 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13472 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13473 src_http_req_cnt.
13474
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013475sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013476sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13477sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13478sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013479 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13480 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13481 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13482 src_http_req_rate.
13483
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013484sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013485sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13486sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13487sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013488 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013489 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13490 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13491 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13492 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013493
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013494 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013495 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13496 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013497 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13498
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013499sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013500sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13501sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13502sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013503 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13504 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13505 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013506
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013507sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013508sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13509sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13510sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013511 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13512 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13513 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013514
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013515sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013516sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13517sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13518sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013519 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13520 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13521 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13522 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013523 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013524 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013526sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013527sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13528sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13529sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013530 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13531 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13532 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13533 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13534 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013535 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013536
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013537sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013538sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13539sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13540sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013541 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13542 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13543 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13544
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013545sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013546sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13547sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13548sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013549 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13550 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013551 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013552 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13553 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013554 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13555 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13556 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013558so_id : integer
13559 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13560 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13561 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013563src : ip
13564 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13565 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13566 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13567 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013568 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13569 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13570 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13571 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013572
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013573 Example:
13574 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13575 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13576
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013577src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13578 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13579 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13580 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013581 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013583src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13584 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13585 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013586 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013587 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013589src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13590 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13591 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13592 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13593 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13594 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13595 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013596
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013597 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013598 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13599 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13600 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13601 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013602 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013603 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13604 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013606src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013607 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013608 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013609 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013610 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013612src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013613 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013614 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13615 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013616 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013617
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013618src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13619 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13620 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13621 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013622 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013624src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013625 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013626 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013627 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013628 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013629
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013630src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13631 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13632 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13633 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13634 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13635
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013636src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013637 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013638 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013639 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13640 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013641 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13642 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13643 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013645src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13646 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13647 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013648 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013649 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013650 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013652src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13653 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13654 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13655 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13656 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013657 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013659src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13660 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13661 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13662 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013663 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013665src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13666 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13667 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13668 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013669 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013670 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013672src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13673 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13674 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13675 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013676 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013677 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13678 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013679
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013680 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013681 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013682 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013683 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013684
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013685src_is_local : boolean
13686 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13687 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13688 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13689 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13690 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13691 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13692 once per connection.
13693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013695 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13696 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13697 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13698 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13699 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013701src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013702 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13703 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13704 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13705 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13706 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013708src_port : integer
13709 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13710 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13711 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13712 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013714src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13715 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013716 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13717 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13718 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013719 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13722 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13723 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13724 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13725 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013726 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013728src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13729 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13730 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13731 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13732 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13733 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13734 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13735 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13736 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013737
13738 Example :
13739 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13740 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13741 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13742 listen ssh
13743 bind :22
13744 mode tcp
13745 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013746 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013747 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013748 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13749
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013750srv_id : integer
13751 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13752 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13753 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013754
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200137557.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013756----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013757
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013758The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13759closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13760when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13761usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013762future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013763
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001376451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13765 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13766 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13767 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13768 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13769 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13770
13771 Example :
13772 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13773 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13774 # the request.
13775 frontend http-in
13776 bind *:8081
13777 default_backend servers
13778 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13779 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13780
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013781ssl_bc : boolean
13782 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13783 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13784 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13785
13786ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13787 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13788 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13789
13790ssl_bc_cipher : string
13791 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13792 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13793
13794ssl_bc_protocol : string
13795 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13796 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13797
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013798ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013799 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013800 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13801 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013802
13803ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13804 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13805 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13806 if session was reused or not.
13807
13808ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13809 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13810 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013812ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13813 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13814 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13815 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13816 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13817 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013819ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13820 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13821 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13822 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13823 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013824
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013825ssl_c_der : binary
13826 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13827 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13828 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013830ssl_c_err : integer
13831 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13832 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13833 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13834 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13835 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013837ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13838 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13839 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13840 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13841 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13842 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13843 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13844 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13845 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013846
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013847ssl_c_key_alg : string
13848 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13849 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13850 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013851
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013852ssl_c_notafter : string
13853 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13854 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13855 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013857ssl_c_notbefore : string
13858 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13859 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13860 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013862ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13863 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13864 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13865 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13866 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13867 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13868 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13869 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13870 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013871
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013872ssl_c_serial : binary
13873 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13874 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13875 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013876
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013877ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13878 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13879 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13880 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013881 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13882 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13883
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013884 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013885 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013887ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13888 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13889 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13890 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013891
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013892ssl_c_used : boolean
13893 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13894 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013895
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013896ssl_c_verify : integer
13897 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13898 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13899 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13900 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013901
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013902ssl_c_version : integer
13903 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13904 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013905
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013906ssl_f_der : binary
13907 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13908 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13909 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013911ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13912 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13913 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13914 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13915 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013916 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013917 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13918 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13919 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013920
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013921ssl_f_key_alg : string
13922 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13923 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13924 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926ssl_f_notafter : string
13927 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13928 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13929 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013931ssl_f_notbefore : string
13932 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13933 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13934 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013936ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13937 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13938 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13939 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13940 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13941 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13942 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13943 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13944 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013946ssl_f_serial : binary
13947 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13948 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13949 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013950
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013951ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13952 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13953 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13954 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013956ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13957 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13958 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13959 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013961ssl_f_version : integer
13962 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13963 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13964
13965ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013966 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13967 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13968 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970 Example :
13971 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13972 listen http-https
13973 bind :80
13974 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13975 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13976
13977ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13978 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13979 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13980
13981ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013982 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013983 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13984 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13985 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13986 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13987 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13988 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13989 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13990 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013992ssl_fc_cipher : string
13993 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13994 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013995
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013996ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
13997 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
13998 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013999 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014000
14001ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14002 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14003 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014004 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014005
14006ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14007 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14008 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14009 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14010 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14011 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14012 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14013
14014ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14015 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14016 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014017 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014020 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14021 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014022 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14023 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14024 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14025 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014027ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14028 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014029 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14030 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14031 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14032 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014033
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014034ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014035 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14036 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014038ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014039 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14041 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14042 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14043 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14044 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14045 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14046 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048ssl_fc_protocol : string
14049 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14050 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014051
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014052ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014053 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014054 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14055 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014056
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014057ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14058 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14059 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14060 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14061 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063ssl_fc_sni : string
14064 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14065 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14066 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14067 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14068 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14069
14070 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14071 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14072 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014073 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14074 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014076 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014077 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14078 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014079
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014080ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14081 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14082 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014083
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014084
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200140857.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014086------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014088Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14089sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14090only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14091For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14092be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14093can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14094sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14095for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14096content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014098payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14099 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14100 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14101 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014103payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14104 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14105 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14106 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014108req.len : integer
14109req_len : integer (deprecated)
14110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14111 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14112 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14113 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14114 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14115 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14116 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14117 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014118
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014119req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14120 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014121 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14122 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14123 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14124 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126 ACL alternatives :
14127 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014129req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14130 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14131 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14132 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14133 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014135 ACL alternatives :
14136 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014138 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014140req.proto_http : boolean
14141req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14142 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14143 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14144 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14145 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14146 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14147 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14148 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150 Example:
14151 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14152 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14153 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014154 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014156req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14157rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14158 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14159 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14160 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14161 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14162 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14163 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14164 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014166 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14167 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14168 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14169 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14170 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14171 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014173 ACL derivatives :
14174 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014176 Example :
14177 listen tse-farm
14178 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14179 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14180 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14181 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14182 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14183 persist rdp-cookie
14184 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14185 # This is only useful makes sense if
14186 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14187 stick-table type string size 204800
14188 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14189 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14190 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014192 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14193 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014195req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14196rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14197 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14198 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14199 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14200 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014201
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014202 ACL derivatives :
14203 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014204
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014205req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14206 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14207 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014208 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14209 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14210 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14211 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14212 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014213
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014214req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14215req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14216 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14217 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14218 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14219 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14220 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14221 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14222 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014223
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014224req.ssl_sni : string
14225req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14226 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14227 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14228 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14229 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14230 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14231 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14232 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14233 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14234 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14235 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14236 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14237 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239 ACL derivatives :
14240 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014242 Examples :
14243 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14244 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14245 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14246 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14247 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014248
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014249req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14250 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14251 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14252 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14253 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14254 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14255 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14256 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14257 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14258 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014260req.ssl_ver : integer
14261req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14262 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14263 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14264 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14265 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14266 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14267 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14268 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14269 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14270 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014271
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014272 ACL derivatives :
14273 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014274
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014275res.len : integer
14276 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14277 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14278 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14279 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14280 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14281 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14282 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14283 content inspection.
14284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014285res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14286 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014287 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14288 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14289 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14290 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014292res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14293 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14294 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14295 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14296 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014299
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014300res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14301rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14302 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14303 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14304 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14305 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14306 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14307 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14308 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310wait_end : boolean
14311 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14312 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14313 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14314 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14315 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14316 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14317 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14318 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014319
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320 Examples :
14321 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14322 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14323 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014325 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14326 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14327 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14328 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14329 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14330 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14331 tcp-request content reject
14332
14333
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200143347.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014335--------------------------------------
14336
14337It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14338This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14339data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14340its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14341HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14342content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14343to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14344more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14345response are indexed.
14346
14347base : string
14348 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14349 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14350 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14351 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14352 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14353 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14354 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14355 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14356
14357 ACL derivatives :
14358 base : exact string match
14359 base_beg : prefix match
14360 base_dir : subdir match
14361 base_dom : domain match
14362 base_end : suffix match
14363 base_len : length match
14364 base_reg : regex match
14365 base_sub : substring match
14366
14367base32 : integer
14368 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14369 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14370 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014371 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14372 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14373 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014374
14375base32+src : binary
14376 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14377 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14378 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14379 per-URL counters.
14380
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014381capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14382 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14383 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14384 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14385
14386capture.req.method : string
14387 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14388 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14389 because it's allocated.
14390
14391capture.req.uri : string
14392 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14393 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14394 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14395 allocated.
14396
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014397capture.req.ver : string
14398 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14399 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14400 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14401
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014402capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14403 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14404 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14405 The first entry is an index of 0.
14406 See also: "capture response header"
14407
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014408capture.res.ver : string
14409 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14410 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14411 persistent flag.
14412
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014413req.body : binary
14414 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14415 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14416 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14417 the first chunk is analyzed.
14418
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014419req.body_param([<name>) : string
14420 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14421 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14422 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14423 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14424 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14425 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14426 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14427 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14428 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14429 given.
14430
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014431req.body_len : integer
14432 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14433 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14434 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14435 "option http-buffer-request".
14436
14437req.body_size : integer
14438 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14439 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14440 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14441 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14442 "option http-buffer-request".
14443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014444req.cook([<name>]) : string
14445cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14446 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14447 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14448 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14449 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14450 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14451 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14452 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14453 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14454
14455 ACL derivatives :
14456 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14457 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14458 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14459 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14460 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14461 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14462 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14463 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014464
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014465req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14466cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14467 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14468 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014470req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14471cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14472 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14473 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14474 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14475 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014477cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14478 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14479 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14480 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14481 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014482 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14484 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14485 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14486 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014488hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14489 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14490 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14491 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14492 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014493 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14496 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14497 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14498 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14499 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14500 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14501 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14502 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14503 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014505req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14506 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14507 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14508 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14509 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014511req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14512 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14513 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14514 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14515 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14516 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14517 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14518 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14519 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14520 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14521 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14522 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014524 ACL derivatives :
14525 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14526 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14527 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14528 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14529 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14530 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14531 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14532 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14533
14534req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14535hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14536 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14537 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14538 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14539 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14540 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14541 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14542 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14543 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14544 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14545
14546req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14547hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14548 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14549 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14550 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14551 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14552 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14553 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14554 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14555 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14556
14557req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14558hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14559 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14560 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14561 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14562 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14563 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14564 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14565 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14566
14567http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14568 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14569 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14570 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14571 basic auth is supported.
14572
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014573http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14574 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14575 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14576 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14577 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014578 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14579 basic auth is supported.
14580
14581 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014582 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14583 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14584 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14585 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014586
14587http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014588 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14589 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014590 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14591 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014592
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014593method : integer + string
14594 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14595 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14596 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14597 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14598 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14599 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14600 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602 ACL derivatives :
14603 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605 Example :
14606 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14607 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14608 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014610path : string
14611 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14612 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14613 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14614 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14615 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14616 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14617 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014619 ACL derivatives :
14620 path : exact string match
14621 path_beg : prefix match
14622 path_dir : subdir match
14623 path_dom : domain match
14624 path_end : suffix match
14625 path_len : length match
14626 path_reg : regex match
14627 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014628
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014629query : string
14630 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14631 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14632 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14633 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014634 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014635 which stops before the question mark.
14636
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014637req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14638 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14639 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14640 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14641 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014643req.ver : string
14644req_ver : string (deprecated)
14645 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14646 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14647 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649 ACL derivatives :
14650 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652res.comp : boolean
14653 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14654 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14655 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657res.comp_algo : string
14658 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14659 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14660 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014662res.cook([<name>]) : string
14663scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14664 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14665 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14666 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014668 ACL derivatives :
14669 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014670
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014671res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14672scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14673 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14674 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14675 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014676
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014677res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14678scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14679 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14680 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14681 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014683res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14684 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14685 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14686 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14687 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14688 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14689 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14690 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14691 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14692 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014694res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14695 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14696 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14697 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14698 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14699 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014701res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14702shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14703 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14704 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14705 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14706 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14707 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14708 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14709 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14710 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014711
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712 ACL derivatives :
14713 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14714 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14715 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14716 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14717 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14718 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14719 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14720 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14721
14722res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14723shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14724 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14725 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14726 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14727 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14728 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014730res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14731shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14732 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14733 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14734 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14735 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14736 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14737 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014738
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014739res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14740 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14741 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14742 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14743 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014745res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14746shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14747 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14748 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14749 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14750 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14751 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14752 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014754res.ver : string
14755resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14756 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14757 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014759 ACL derivatives :
14760 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014762set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14763 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14764 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014765 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014766 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014768 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14769 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014771status : integer
14772 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14773 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14774 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014775
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014776unique-id : string
14777 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14778 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14779 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14780 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14781 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14782 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014784url : string
14785 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14786 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14787 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14788 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14789 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14790 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14791 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793 ACL derivatives :
14794 url : exact string match
14795 url_beg : prefix match
14796 url_dir : subdir match
14797 url_dom : domain match
14798 url_end : suffix match
14799 url_len : length match
14800 url_reg : regex match
14801 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014803url_ip : ip
14804 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14805 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14806 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14807 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14808 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14809 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14810 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014812url_port : integer
14813 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14814 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14815 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14816 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014817
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014818urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14819url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14821 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014822 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14823 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14824 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14825 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014826 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14827 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014828 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14829 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014831 ACL derivatives :
14832 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14833 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14834 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14835 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14836 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14837 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14838 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14839 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014840
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014841
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014842 Example :
14843 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14844 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14845 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14846 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014847
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014848urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014849 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14850 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14851 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014852
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014853url32 : integer
14854 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14855 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14856 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14857 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14858 is an unsigned integer.
14859
14860url32+src : binary
14861 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14862 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14863 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14864
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200148667.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014867---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014868
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014869Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14870every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014871order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014872
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014873ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14874---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014875FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014876HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014877HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14878HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014879HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14880HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14881HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14882HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14883LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014884METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014885METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014886METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14887METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14888METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14889METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014890METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014891METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014892RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014893REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014894TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014895WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14896---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014897
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014898
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148998. Logging
14900----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014901
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014902One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14903provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14904very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14905provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14906state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014907to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014908headers.
14909
14910In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14911about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14912send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14913
14914 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14915 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14916 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14917 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14918 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014919 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14920 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014921
14922The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14923allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14924as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14925while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14926real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14927delay.
14928
14929
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149308.1. Log levels
14931---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014932
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014933TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014934source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014935HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14936in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14937track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14938syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14939about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014940
14941
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149428.2. Log formats
14943----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014944
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014945HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014946and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14947slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14948options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014949
14950 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14951 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14952 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14953 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14954 extents.
14955
14956 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14957 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14958 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14959 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14960 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14961
14962 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14963 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14964 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14965 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14966 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14967
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014968 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14969 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14970 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14971 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14972
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014973 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14974
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014975Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14976specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14977field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14978servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14979always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14980identifier.
14981
14982Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14983 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14984 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14985 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14986 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14987
14988
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149898.2.1. Default log format
14990-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014991
14992This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14993as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14994format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14995
14996 Example :
14997 listen www
14998 mode http
14999 log global
15000 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15001
15002 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15003 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15004 (www/HTTP)
15005
15006 Field Format Extract from the example above
15007 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15008 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15009 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15010 4 'to' to
15011 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15012 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15013
15014Detailed fields description :
15015 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15016 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15017 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15018 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15019 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15020 and processed the connection.
15021 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15022
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015023In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15024"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15025connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015027It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15028will eventually disappear.
15029
15030
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150318.2.2. TCP log format
15032---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015033
15034The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15035is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15036information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15037counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15038emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15039environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15040the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15041sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015042specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15043not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15044fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15045marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015046
15047 Example :
15048 frontend fnt
15049 mode tcp
15050 option tcplog
15051 log global
15052 default_backend bck
15053
15054 backend bck
15055 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15056
15057 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15058 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15059 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15060
15061 Field Format Extract from the example above
15062 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15063 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15064 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15065 4 frontend_name fnt
15066 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15067 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15068 7 bytes_read* 212
15069 8 termination_state --
15070 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15071 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15072
15073Detailed fields description :
15074 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015075 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15076 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15077 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015078 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15079 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15080 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015081
15082 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015083 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15084 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15085 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015086
15087 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15088 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15089 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15090 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15091
15092 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15093 and processed the connection.
15094
15095 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15096 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15097 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15098 applications.
15099
15100 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15101 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15102 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15103 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15104 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15105
15106 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15107 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15108 See "Timers" below for more details.
15109
15110 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15111 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15112 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15113 "Timers" below for more details.
15114
15115 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015116 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015117 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15118 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15119 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15120 details.
15121
15122 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15123 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15124 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15125 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15126 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15127
15128 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15129 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15130 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15131 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15132 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15133 for more details.
15134
15135 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015136 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015137 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15138 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15139 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015140 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015141
15142 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15143 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15144 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15145 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15146 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15147 caused by a denial of service attack.
15148
15149 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15150 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15151 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15152 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15153 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15154 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15155 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15156 denial of service attack.
15157
15158 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15159 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15160 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15161 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15162 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15163 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15164 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15165 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15166 be processed than on other servers.
15167
15168 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15169 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15170 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15171 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15172 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15173 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15174 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15175 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15176 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15177 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15178 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15179 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15180 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15181
15182 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15183 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15184 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15185 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15186 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15187 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15188 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15189 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15190
15191 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15192 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15193 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15194 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15195 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15196 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15197 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15198 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15199 occurs.
15200
15201
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152028.2.3. HTTP log format
15203----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015204
15205The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15206is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15207the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15208are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15209emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15210generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15211"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15212which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015213frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15214is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015215
15216Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15217slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15218with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15219
15220 Example :
15221 frontend http-in
15222 mode http
15223 option httplog
15224 log global
15225 default_backend bck
15226
15227 backend static
15228 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15229
15230 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15231 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15232 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015233 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015234
15235 Field Format Extract from the example above
15236 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15237 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015238 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015239 4 frontend_name http-in
15240 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015241 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015242 7 status_code 200
15243 8 bytes_read* 2750
15244 9 captured_request_cookie -
15245 10 captured_response_cookie -
15246 11 termination_state ----
15247 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15248 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15249 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15250 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15251 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015252
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015253Detailed fields description :
15254 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015255 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15256 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15257 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015258 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15259 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15260 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015261
15262 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015263 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15264 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15265 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015266
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015267 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15268 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015269
15270 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15271 and processed the connection.
15272
15273 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15274 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15275 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15276
15277 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15278 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15279 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15280 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15281 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15282 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15283
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015284 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15285 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15286 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15287 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15288 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15289 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15290 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015291
15292 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15293 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15294 See "Timers" below for more details.
15295
15296 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15297 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15298 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15299 below for more details.
15300
15301 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15302 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15303 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15304 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15305 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15306 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15307 for more details.
15308
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015309 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15310 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15311 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15312 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15313 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15314 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15315 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15316 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015317
15318 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15319 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15320 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15321
15322 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15323 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15324 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15325 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15326 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15327 overflowing.
15328
15329 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15330 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15331 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15332 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15333 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15334 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15335 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15336 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15337
15338 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15339 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15340 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15341 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15342 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15343 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15344 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15345 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15346
15347 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15348 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15349 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15350 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15351 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15352 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15353 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15354
15355 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015356 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015357 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15358 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15359 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015360 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015361 system.
15362
15363 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15364 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15365 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15366 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15367 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15368 caused by a denial of service attack.
15369
15370 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15371 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15372 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15373 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15374 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15375 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15376 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15377 denial of service attack.
15378
15379 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15380 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15381 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15382 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15383 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15384 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15385 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15386 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15387 processed than on other servers.
15388
15389 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15390 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15391 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15392 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15393 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15394 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15395 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15396 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15397 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15398 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15399 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15400 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15401 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15402
15403 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15404 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15405 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15406 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15407 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15408 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15409 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15410 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15411
15412 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15413 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15414 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15415 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15416 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15417 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15418 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15419 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15420 occurs.
15421
15422 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15423 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15424 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15425 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15426 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15427 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15428 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15429 cookies" below for more details.
15430
15431 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15432 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15433 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15434 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15435 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15436 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15437 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15438 and cookies" below for more details.
15439
15440 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15441 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15442 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15443 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15444 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15445 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15446 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15447 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15448
15449
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200154508.2.4. Custom log format
15451------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015452
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015453The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015454mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015455
15456HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15457Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15458separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15459prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15460
15461Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15462variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015463("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015464
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015465If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015466as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015467less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15468the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15469
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015470Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015471In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015472in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015473
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015474Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15475'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15476https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15477such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15478
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015479Flags are :
15480 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015481 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015482 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15483 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015484
15485 Example:
15486
15487 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15488 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15489
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015490 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15491
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015492At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15493
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015494 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15495 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015496
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015497the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015498
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015499 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15500 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15501 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015502
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015503and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15504
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015505 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15506 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015507
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015508Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15509
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015510 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015511 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015512 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15513 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15514 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015515 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15516 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15517 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015518 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015519 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15520 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015521 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015522 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15523 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015524 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015525 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015526 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015527 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015528 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015529 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015530 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015531 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15532 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15533 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15534 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15535 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015536 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015537 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15538 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015539 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015540 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15541 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015542 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15543 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15544 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015545 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015546 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15547 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015548 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015549 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15550 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15551 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015552 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015553 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015554 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15555 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15556 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15557 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015558 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015559 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015560 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015561 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015562 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015563 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015564 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15565 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15566 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015567 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015568 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15569 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015570 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015571 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15572 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15573 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015574 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015575 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015576 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015577
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015578 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015579
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015580
155818.2.5. Error log format
15582-----------------------
15583
15584When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15585protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15586By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15587"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15588will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15589logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15590
15591The format looks like this :
15592
15593 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15594 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15595 Connection error during SSL handshake
15596
15597 Field Format Extract from the example above
15598 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15599 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15600 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15601 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15602 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15603
15604These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15605failures.
15606
15607
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156088.3. Advanced logging options
15609-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015610
15611Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15612just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15613options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15614for more information about their usage.
15615
15616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156178.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15618------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015619
15620It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15621haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15622commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15623monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15624ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15625
15626 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15627 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15628 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15629 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15630
15631 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15632 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15633 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015634 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015635 such as other load-balancers.
15636
15637 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15638 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15639 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15640
15641
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156428.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15643----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015644
15645The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15646what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15647or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15648"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15649just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15650log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15651after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15652is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15653with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15654with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15655
15656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156578.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15658------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015659
15660Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15661for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15662"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15663retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15664raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15665a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15666file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15667you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15668"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15669
15670
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156718.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15672--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015673
15674Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15675multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15676them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15677"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15678logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15679error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15680and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15681too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15682useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15683alternative.
15684
15685
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156868.4. Timing events
15687------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015688
15689Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15690reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15691the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15692frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015693mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15694addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15695
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015696Timings events in HTTP mode:
15697
15698 first request 2nd request
15699 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15700 t tr t tr ...
15701 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15702 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15703 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15704 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15705 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15706
15707Timings events in TCP mode:
15708
15709 TCP session
15710 |<----------------->|
15711 t t
15712 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15713 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15714 |<------ Tt ------->|
15715
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015716 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15717 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15718 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15719 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15720 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15721 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15722 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015723
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015724 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15725 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15726 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15727 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15728 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15729 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15730 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15731 nothing was received on the connection.
15732
15733 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15734 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15735 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15736 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15737 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15738 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15739 request typed by hand during a test.
15740
15741 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15742 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15743 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15744 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15745 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15746 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15747 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015748
15749 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15750 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15751 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15752 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15753 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15754
15755 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15756 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15757 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15758 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15759 connection never established.
15760
15761 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15762 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15763 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15764 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15765 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15766 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15767 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15768 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15769 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15770 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15771 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15772
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015773 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15774 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15775 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15776 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15777 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15778 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15779
15780 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15781
15782 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15783 "Ta" can never be negative.
15784
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015785 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15786 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015787 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15788 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015789 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015790
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015791 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015792
15793 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015794 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15795 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015796
15797These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15798protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15799that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015800due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15801"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15802that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015803
15804Most common cases :
15805
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015806 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15807 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15808 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15809 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15810 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15811 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15812 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15813 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15814 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15815 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15816 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015817 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015818
15819 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15820 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15821 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15822 of ms on remote networks.
15823
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015824 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15825 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15826 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015827
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015828 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15829 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15830 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15831 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15832 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15833 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15834 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15835 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15836 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015837
15838Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15839
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015840 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015841 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015842 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015843
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015844 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015845 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15846 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15847
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015848 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015849 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15850 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15851 flags.
15852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015853 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15854 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015855 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15856 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15857 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15858 the client connection was maintained open.
15859
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015860 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015861 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015862 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015863 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15864
15865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158668.5. Session state at disconnection
15867-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015868
15869TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15870"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
158712-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15872each of which has a special meaning :
15873
15874 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15875 session to terminate :
15876
15877 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15878
15879 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15880 server explicitly refused it.
15881
15882 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15883 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15884 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15885 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015886 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15887
15888 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15889 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015890
15891 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15892 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15893 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15894 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15895 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15896
15897 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15898 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15899 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15900 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15901 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15902
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015903 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15904 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15905
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015906 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15907 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15908 backup connections when going up.
15909
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015910 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15911
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015912 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15913 send or receive data.
15914
15915 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15916 send or receive data.
15917
15918 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15919 with nothing left in the buffers.
15920
15921 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15922
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015923 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015924 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15925
15926 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15927 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15928 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15929 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15930 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15931
15932 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15933 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15934
15935 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15936 server (HTTP only).
15937
15938 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15939
15940 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15941 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15942 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15943
15944 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15945 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15946 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15947
15948 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15949
15950 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15951 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15952
15953 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15954 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15955 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15956
15957 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15958 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015959 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15960 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015961
15962 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15963 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15964 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15965 another server.
15966
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015967 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015968 server.
15969
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015970 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15971 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15972 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15973 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15974
15975 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15976 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15977 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15978 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15979
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015980 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15981 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15982 "use-server" rule).
15983
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015984 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15985
15986 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15987 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15988
15989 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15990
15991 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15992 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15993 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15994
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015995 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15996 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015997 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015998 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15999 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16000
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016001 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16002
16003 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16004 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16005
16006 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16007
16008 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16009
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016010The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16011was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016012helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16013starvation, attacks, etc...
16014
16015The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16016alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16017easier finding and understanding.
16018
16019 Flags Reason
16020
16021 -- Normal termination.
16022
16023 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16024 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16025 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16026 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16027
16028 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16029 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16030 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16031 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16032 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16033 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016034
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016035 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16036 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016037 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016038
16039 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16040 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16041 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16042
16043 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16044 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16045 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16046 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16047 the server takes too long to respond.
16048
16049 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16050 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16051 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16052 long a time to respond.
16053
16054 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16055 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16056 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16057 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016058 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16059 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016060
16061 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16062 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16063 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16064 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16065 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016066 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016067 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16068 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16069 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16070 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16071 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16072 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16073 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16074 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16075 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16076 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16077 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16078 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016079
16080 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16081 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016082 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16083 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16084 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16085 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016086
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016087 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16088 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16089
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016090 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016091 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16092 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16093 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16094 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16095 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16096
16097 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16098 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16099 503 or 504 here.
16100
16101 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16102 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16103 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16104 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16105 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16106
16107 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16108 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016109 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016110 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16111 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16112
16113 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16114 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16115 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16116 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16117 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16118 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16119 between haproxy and the server.
16120
16121 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16122 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16123 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16124 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16125 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16126 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16127 solution is to fix the application.
16128
16129 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16130 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16131 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16132 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16133 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16134 external attacks.
16135
16136 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16137 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016138 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016139 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16140 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16141
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016142 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16143 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16144 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016145 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16146 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016147
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16149 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16150 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16151 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016152 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16153 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16154 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16155 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16156 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016157
16158 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16159 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16160 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16161 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16162
16163 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16164 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16165 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16166 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16167
16168 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16169 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16170 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16171 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16172
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016173The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16174persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16175important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16176re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16177
16178 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16179
16180 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16181 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16182 set on a GET request.
16183
16184 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16185 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016186 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016187 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16188
16189 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16190 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16191 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16192
16193 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16194 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16195 already got a cookie.
16196
16197 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16198 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16199 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16200 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16201 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16202
16203 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16204 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16205 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16206
16207 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16208 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16209 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16210
16211 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16212 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16213
16214 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16215 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16216 then advertised in the response.
16217
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162198.6. Non-printable characters
16220-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016221
16222In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16223consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16224converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16225prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16226being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16227escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16228is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16229'}' when logging headers.
16230
16231Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16232issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16233containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16234
16235Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16236the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16237performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16238
16239
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162408.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16241---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016242
16243Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16244achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016245section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016246cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16247the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16248the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016249locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016250not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16251user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16252a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16253wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16254
16255 Examples :
16256 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16257 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16258
16259 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16260 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16261
16262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162638.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16264---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016265
16266Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16267proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16268the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16269server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16270
16271Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16272response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016273section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016274
16275It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016276time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16277appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016278are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16279and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16280follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16281request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16282in the logs.
16283
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016284As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16285frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16286an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16287
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016288 Example :
16289 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16290 listen proxy-out
16291 mode http
16292 option httplog
16293 option logasap
16294 log global
16295 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16296
16297 # log the name of the virtual server
16298 capture request header Host len 20
16299
16300 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16301 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16302
16303 # log the beginning of the referrer
16304 capture request header Referer len 20
16305
16306 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16307 capture response header Server len 20
16308
16309 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16310 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16311
16312 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16313 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16314
16315 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16316 capture response header Via len 20
16317
16318 # log the URL location during a redirection
16319 capture response header Location len 20
16320
16321 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16322 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16323 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16324 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16325 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16326
16327 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16328 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16329 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16330 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016331 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016332
16333 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16334 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16335 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16336 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16337 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016338 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016339
16340
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163418.9. Examples of logs
16342---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016343
16344These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16345them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16346reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16347
16348 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16349 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16350 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16351
16352 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16353 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16354
16355 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16356 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16357 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16358
16359 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16360 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16361
16362 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16363 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16364 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16365
16366 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016367 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016368 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16369 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16370
16371 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16372 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16373 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16374
16375 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16376 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016377 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016378 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16379 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16380 to return the 502 and not the server.
16381
16382 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016383 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016384
16385 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16386 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16387 Nothing was sent to any server.
16388
16389 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16390 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16391
16392 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16393 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16394 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16395 send a 408 return code to the client.
16396
16397 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16398 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16399
16400 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16401 5 seconds ("c----").
16402
16403 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16404 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016405 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016406
16407 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016408 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016409 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16410 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16411 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16412 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16413 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016414
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016415
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200164169. Supported filters
16417--------------------
16418
16419Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16420accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16421unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16422
16423See also : "filter"
16424
164259.1. Trace
16426----------
16427
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016428filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016429
16430 Arguments:
16431 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16432 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16433
16434 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16435 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16436 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16437 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16438
16439 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16440 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16441 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16442 amount of the parsed data.
16443
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016444 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16445
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016446This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16447callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16448information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16449filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16450
16451Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16452tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16453a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16454
16455
164569.2. HTTP compression
16457---------------------
16458
16459filter compression
16460
16461The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16462keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16463when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16464use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16465used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16466filters evaluation order.
16467
16468See also : "compression"
16469
16470
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200164719.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16472--------------------------------------------
16473
16474filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16475
16476 Arguments :
16477
16478 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16479 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16480 parsed.
16481
16482 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16483 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16484 part must be placed in its own scope.
16485
16486The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16487external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16488streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16489exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16490also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16491
16492SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16493the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16494
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016495For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016496"doc/SPOE.txt".
16497
16498Important note:
16499 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16500 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16501
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016502/*
16503 * Local variables:
16504 * fill-column: 79
16505 * End:
16506 */